blob: ebbc6fdfa911810fae7463f979422d4a5eccffc0 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau396d2002020-04-02 09:02:11 +02007 2020/04/02
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100193For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
194the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
196is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
197servers.
198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199
2001.2. HTTP request
201-----------------
202
203First, let's consider this HTTP request :
204
205 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100206 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
208 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
209 3 User-agent: my small browser
210 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
211 5 Accept: image/png
212
213
2141.2.1. The Request line
215-----------------------
216
217Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
218
219 - a METHOD : GET
220 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
222
223All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
224which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
225followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
226is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
227desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
228the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
229
230The URI itself can have several forms :
231
232 - A "relative URI" :
233
234 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235
236 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
237 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
238
239 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
240
241 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
244 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
245 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
246 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
247 must accept this form too.
248
249 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
250 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
251 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200253 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
254 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
255 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
256 other protocols too.
257
258In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
259mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
260on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
261It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
262specific to the language, framework or application in use.
263
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100264HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100265assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100266However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
267received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
268processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
269as well as in server logs.
270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271
2721.2.2. The request headers
273--------------------------
274
275The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
276beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
277an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
278Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
279values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
280encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
281the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
282define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
283
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100284Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
287as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288
289The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
290that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
291is one valid form of empty line.
292
293Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
294headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
295about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
296application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
297
298Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000299 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
301 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
302 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
303
304
3051.3. HTTP response
306------------------
307
308An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
309messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
310
311 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
314 2 Content-length: 350
315 3 Content-Type: text/html
316
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200317As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
318codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
319response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100320continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
321the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
322following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
323sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
324(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
325correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
326such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
327state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
328over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
329if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
330information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334------------------------
335
336Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
337
338 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
339 - a status code : 200
340 - a reason : OK
341
342The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100343 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
344 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
345 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
346 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
347 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200348
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000349Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100350"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
352messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
353or "Authentication Required".
354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
357 Code When / reason
358 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
359 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
361 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100362 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
363 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364 400 for an invalid or too large request
365 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
366 accessing the stats page)
367 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
368 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
369 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
370 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
371 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
372 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
373 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
374 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
375 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
376
377The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3784.2).
379
380
3811.3.2. The response headers
382---------------------------
383
384Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
385the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
386details.
387
388
3892. Configuring HAProxy
390----------------------
391
3922.1. Configuration file format
393------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200394
395HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
396
397 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
398 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
399 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
400 "frontend" and "backend".
401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100402The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
403referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200404delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200406
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004072.2. Quoting and escaping
408-------------------------
409
410HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
411many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
412with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
413single quotes.
414
415If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
416them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
417escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
418
419Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
420
421 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
422 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
423 \\ to use a backslash
424 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
425 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
426
427Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
428the interpretation of:
429
430 space as a parameter separator
431 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
432 # hash as a comment start
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200434Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
435-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
436backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
437
438Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200439quoting.
440
441Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
442nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
443
444Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
445equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
446
447 Example:
448 # those are equivalents:
449 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
451 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
453 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
454
455 # those are equivalents:
456 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
459 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
460
461
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004622.3. Environment variables
463--------------------------
464
465HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
466interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
467configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
468optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
469shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
470underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
471
472 Example:
473
474 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
475
476 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
477
478 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
479
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200480Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
481file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200482
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200483* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
484 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
485
486* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
487 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
488 directory.
489
490* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
491
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500492* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493 processes, separated by semicolons.
494
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500495* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496 CLI, separated by semicolons.
497
498See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200499
5002.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200501----------------
502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100503Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100504values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
505otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
506numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
507for every keyword. Supported units are :
508
509 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
510 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
511 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
512 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
513 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
514 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
515
516
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005172.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200518-------------
519
520 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
521 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
522 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
523 global
524 daemon
525 maxconn 256
526
527 defaults
528 mode http
529 timeout connect 5000ms
530 timeout client 50000ms
531 timeout server 50000ms
532
533 frontend http-in
534 bind *:80
535 default_backend servers
536
537 backend servers
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
542 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
543 global
544 daemon
545 maxconn 256
546
547 defaults
548 mode http
549 timeout connect 5000ms
550 timeout client 50000ms
551 timeout server 50000ms
552
553 listen http-in
554 bind *:80
555 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
556
557
558Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
559
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100560 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200561
562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005633. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564--------------------
565
566Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
567are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
568of them have command-line equivalents.
569
570The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
571
572 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200573 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200575 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200578 - description
579 - deviceatlas-json-file
580 - deviceatlas-log-level
581 - deviceatlas-separator
582 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900583 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - gid
585 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100586 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200587 - h1-case-adjust
588 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100591 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200593 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200595 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200596 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100598 - presetenv
599 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600 - uid
601 - ulimit-n
602 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200603 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100604 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200605 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200607 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - ssl-default-bind-options
609 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200610 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200611 - ssl-default-server-options
612 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100613 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100614 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100616 - 51degrees-data-file
617 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200618 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200619 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200620 - wurfl-data-file
621 - wurfl-information-list
622 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200623 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100624
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200625 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200626 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200628 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100629 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100630 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100631 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200632 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200633 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200634 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200635 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636 - noepoll
637 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000638 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200639 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100640 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300641 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000642 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100643 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200644 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200645 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200646 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000647 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000648 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200649 - tune.buffers.limit
650 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200651 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200652 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100653 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200654 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200655 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200656 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100657 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200658 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200659 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100660 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100661 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100662 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100663 - tune.lua.session-timeout
664 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200665 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100666 - tune.maxaccept
667 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200668 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200669 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200670 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100671 - tune.rcvbuf.client
672 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100673 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200674 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100675 - tune.sndbuf.client
676 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100677 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100678 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200679 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100680 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200681 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200682 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100683 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200684 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100685 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200686 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
687 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
688 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100689 - tune.zlib.memlevel
690 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100691
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200692 * Debugging
693 - debug
694 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200695
696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006973.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200698------------------------------------
699
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200700ca-base <dir>
701 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200702 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
703 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200704
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200705chroot <jail dir>
706 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
707 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
708 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
709 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
710 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100712
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100713cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
714 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
715 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
716 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
717 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
718 set. These sets have the format
719
720 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
721
722 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100723 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100724 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
725 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100726 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
727 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100728 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100729 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100731 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100732 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
733 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
734 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
735 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100736
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100737 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
738 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
739 on the machine's word size.
740
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
743 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
744 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
745 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
746 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
747 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100748
749 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
751
752 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
753 # first 4 CPUs
754
755 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
756 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
757 # word size.
758
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100759 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100761 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
762 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
763 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
764
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100765 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
766 # and so on.
767 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
768 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
769 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100771 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100772 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
773 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
774 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
775
776 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
777 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
778 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
779
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100780 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
781 # and a thread range.
782 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
783 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
784 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
785
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200786crt-base <dir>
787 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
788 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
789 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
790
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200791daemon
792 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
793 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100794 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
795 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200796
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200797deviceatlas-json-file <path>
798 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100799 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200800
801deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100802 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200803 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
804
805deviceatlas-separator <char>
806 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
807 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
808
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100809deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200810 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
811 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
812 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100813
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900814external-check
815 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
816 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
817 See "option external-check".
818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819gid <number>
820 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
821 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
822 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100823 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
824 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200825 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Willy Tarreau8b852462019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100827group <group name>
828 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
829 See also "gid" and "user".
830
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100831hard-stop-after <time>
832 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
833
834 Arguments :
835 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
836 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
837 SIGUSR1 signal.
838
839 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
840 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
841 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
842
843 Example:
844 global
845 hard-stop-after 30s
846
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200847h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
848 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
849 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
850 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
851 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin5c836fd2020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500852 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200853 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
854 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
855 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
856 specified in a proxy.
857
858 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
859 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
860 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
861 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
862 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
863 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
864 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
865
866 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
867 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
868 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
869 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
870 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
871
872 Example:
873 global
874 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
875
876 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
877 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
878
879h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
880 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
881 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
882 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
883 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
884 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
885 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
886 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
887 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
888
889 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
890 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
891 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
892
893 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
894 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
895
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200896log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
897 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100898 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100899 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100900 configured with "log global".
901
902 <address> can be one of:
903
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100904 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100905 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
906 port).
907
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100908 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
909 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
910 port).
911
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100912 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100913 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
914 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100915 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100916
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100917 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
918 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
919 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
920 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
921 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
922 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
923 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
924 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
925 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
926 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
927 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
928 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
929 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
930 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100931 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
932 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100933
934 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
935 "fd@2", see above.
936
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200937 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
938 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100939
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200940 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
941 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
942 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
943 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
944 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
945 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
946 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
947 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
948 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
949 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100950 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
951 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200952
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200953 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
954 one of the following :
955
956 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
957 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
958
959 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
960 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
961
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100962 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
963 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
964 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
965 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
966 logger consumes.
967
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100968 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
969 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
970 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
971 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
972
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200973 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
974 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
975 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
976 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
977 set with <sample_size> parameter.
978
979 <sample_size>
980 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
981 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
982 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
983 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
984 (see also <ranges> parameter).
985
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100986 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200987
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100988 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
989 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
990 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
991
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100992 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
993 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
994 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
995 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200996
997 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200998 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
999 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1000 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1001 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1002 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1003 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001004
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001005 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001007log-send-hostname [<string>]
1008 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1009 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1010 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1011 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1012 the logs.
1013
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001014log-tag <string>
1015 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1016 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1017 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001018 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001019
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001020lua-load <file>
1021 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1022 used multiple times.
1023
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001024master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001025 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1026 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1027 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001028 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001029 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1030 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001031 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1032 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1033 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1034 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1035 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001036
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001037 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001038
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001039mworker-max-reloads <number>
1040 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001041 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001042 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1043 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1044 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1045
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001046nbproc <number>
1047 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1048 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1049 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001050 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1051 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001052 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1053 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001054
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001055nbthread <number>
1056 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001057 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1058 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1059 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1060 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1061 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001062 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1063 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1064 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1065 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1066 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1067 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1068 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001069
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001071 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001072 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1073 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1074
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001075presetenv <name> <value>
1076 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1077 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1078 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1079 and "unsetenv".
1080
1081resetenv [<name> ...]
1082 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1083 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1084 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1085 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1086 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1087 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1088 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1089 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1090
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001091stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001092 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1093 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1094 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1095 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1096 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1097 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001098 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001099 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1100 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1101 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1102 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001103
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001104server-state-base <directory>
1105 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001106 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1107 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001108
1109server-state-file <file>
1110 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1111 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1112 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1113 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1114 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1115 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1116 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1117 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001118 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1119 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001120
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001121setenv <name> <value>
1122 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1123 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1124 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1125 and "unsetenv".
1126
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001127set-dumpable
1128 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1129 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1130 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1131 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1132 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1133 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1134 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1135 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1136 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1137 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1138 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1139 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1140 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1141 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1142 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1143 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1144 expected when dying.
1145
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001146ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1147 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1148 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001149 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001150 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001151 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1152 information and recommendations see e.g.
1153 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1154 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1155 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1156 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001157
1158ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1160 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1161 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1162 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1163 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001164 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1165 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1166 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001167 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001168
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001169ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1170 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1171 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1172 keyword to see available options.
1173
1174 Example:
1175 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001176 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001177
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001178ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1180 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001181 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001182 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001183 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1184 information and recommendations see e.g.
1185 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1186 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1187 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1188 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1189 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001190
1191ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1193 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1194 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1195 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1196 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001197 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1198 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1199 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1200 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001201
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001202ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1204 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1205 keyword to see available options.
1206
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001207ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1208 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1209 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1210 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001211 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001212 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001213 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1214 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1215 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1216 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001217 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1218 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1219 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1220
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001221ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1222 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1223 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1224 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1225
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001226stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1227 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1228 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1229 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001230 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001231 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001232
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001233 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1234 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1235 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001236
1237stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1238 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1239 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001240 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001241
1242stats maxconn <connections>
1243 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1244 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1245
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001246uid <number>
1247 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1248 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1249 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1250 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1251
1252ulimit-n <number>
1253 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1254 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1255 option.
1256
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001257unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1258 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1259
1260 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1261 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1262 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1263 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1264 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1265 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1266 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1267 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1268 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1269 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1270
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001271unsetenv [<name> ...]
1272 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1273 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1274 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1275 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1276 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1277 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1278 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1279
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001280user <user name>
1281 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1282 See also "uid" and "group".
1283
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001284node <name>
1285 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1286
1287 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1288 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1289 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1290 traffic.
1291
1292description <text>
1293 Add a text that describes the instance.
1294
1295 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1296 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1297 "<" and ">" characters.
1298
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100129951degrees-data-file <file path>
1300 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001301 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001302
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001303 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001304 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1305
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000130651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001307 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1308 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1309 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1310
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001311 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001312 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1313
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200131451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001315 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1316 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1317
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001318 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1319 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1320
132151degrees-cache-size <number>
1322 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1323 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1324 By default, this cache is disabled.
1325
1326 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001327 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1328
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001329wurfl-data-file <file path>
1330 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1331 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1332
1333 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1334 with USE_WURFL=1.
1335
1336wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1337 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1338 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1339 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1340
1341 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1342
1343 Valid WURFL properties are:
1344 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1345
1346 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1347 device.
1348
1349 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1350 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1351
1352 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1353 particular web request.
1354
1355 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1356 used Libwurfl API version.
1357
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001358 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1359 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1360
1361 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1362 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1363
1364 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1365
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001366 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1367 with USE_WURFL=1.
1368
1369wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1370 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1371 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1372
1373 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1374 with USE_WURFL=1.
1375
1376wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1377 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1378 thus before the chroot.
1379
1380 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1381 with USE_WURFL=1.
1382
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001383wurfl-cache-size <size>
1384 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1385 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001386 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001387 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001388
1389 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1390 with USE_WURFL=1.
1391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013923.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001393-----------------------
1394
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001395busy-polling
1396 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1397 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1398 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1399 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1400 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1401 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1402 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1403 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1404 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1405 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1406 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1407 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1408 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1409 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1410 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1411 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1412 "poll" pollers.
1413
William Dauchy857b9432019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001414 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1415 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1416 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1417
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001418max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1419 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1420 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1421 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1422 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1423 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1424 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1425 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1426 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1427
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001428maxconn <number>
1429 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1430 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1431 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001432 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1433 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1434 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1435 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001436 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1437 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1438 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1439 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1440 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1441 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001442
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001443maxconnrate <number>
1444 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1445 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1446 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1447 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1448 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1449 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1450 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1451 fairness.
1452
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001453maxcomprate <number>
1454 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001455 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001456 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1457 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1458 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001459 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001460 default value.
1461
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001462maxcompcpuusage <number>
1463 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1464 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1465 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1466 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1467 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1468 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1469 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1470 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1471
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001472maxpipes <number>
1473 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1474 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1475 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1476 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1477 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1478 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1479
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001480maxsessrate <number>
1481 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1482 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1483 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1484 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1485 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1486 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1487 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1488 fairness.
1489
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001490maxsslconn <number>
1491 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1492 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1493 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1494 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1495 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1496 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1497 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001498 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1499 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1500 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1501 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1502 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1503 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1504 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001505
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001506maxsslrate <number>
1507 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1508 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1509 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1510 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1511 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1512 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1513 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1514 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1515 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1516 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1517
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001518maxzlibmem <number>
1519 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1520 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1521 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001522 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1523 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1524 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1525
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001526noepoll
1527 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1528 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001529 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001530
1531nokqueue
1532 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1533 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1534 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1535
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001536noevports
1537 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1538 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1539 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1540 also "nopoll".
1541
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001542nopoll
1543 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1544 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001545 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001546 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1547 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001548
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001549nosplice
1550 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001551 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001552 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001553 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001554 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1555 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1556 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1557 "option splice-response".
1558
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001559nogetaddrinfo
1560 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1561 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1562
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001563noreuseport
1564 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1565 command line argument "-dR".
1566
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001567profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1568 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1569 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1570 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1571 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001572 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001573 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1574 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1575 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1576 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1577
1578 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1579 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1580 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1581 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1582 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001583 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1584 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1585 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1586 CLI.
1587
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001588spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001589 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1590 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1591 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1592 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1593 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1594 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001595
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001596ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001597 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001598 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001599 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1600 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1601 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1602 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1603 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001604 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1605 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001606 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1607 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1608 openssl configuration file uses:
1609 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1610
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001611ssl-mode-async
1612 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001613 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001614 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1615 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1616 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001617 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001618 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001619
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001620tune.buffers.limit <number>
1621 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1622 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1623 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1624 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1625 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001626 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001627 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1628 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1629 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1630 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1631 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1632 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1633 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1634 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1635 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1636
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001637tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1638 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1639 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1640 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1641 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1642
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001643tune.bufsize <number>
1644 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1645 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1646 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1647 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1648 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1649 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1650 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001651 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1652 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1653 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001654 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001655 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1656 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1657 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001658
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001659tune.chksize <number>
1660 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1661 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1662 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1663 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1664 checks whenever possible.
1665
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001666tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1667 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1668 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1669 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1670 this value. The default value is 1.
1671
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001672tune.fail-alloc
1673 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1674 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1675 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1676 gracefully.
1677
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001678tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1679 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1680 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1681 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1682 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1683 change it.
1684
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001685tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1686 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001687 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1688 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001689 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1690 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1691 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1692 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1693 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1694
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001695tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1696 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1697 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1698 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1699 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1700 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1701 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1702 recommended not to change this value.
1703
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001704tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1705 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1706 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1707 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1708 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1709 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1710 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1711 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1712
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001713tune.http.cookielen <number>
1714 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1715 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1716 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1717 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1718 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1719 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1720 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1721 to change this value.
1722
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001723tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001724 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1725 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001726 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001727 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001728 configuration directives too.
1729 The default value is 1024.
1730
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001731tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1732 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1733 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1734 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1735 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1736 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1737 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001738 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1739 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1740 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001741
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001742tune.idletimer <timeout>
1743 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1744 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1745 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1746 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1747 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1748 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001749 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001750 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001751 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1752
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001753tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1754 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1755 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1756 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1757 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1758 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1759 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1760 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1761 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1762 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1763
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001764tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1765 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001766 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001767 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1768 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001769 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001770 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1771 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1772
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001773tune.lua.maxmem
1774 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1775 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1776 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1777 memory.
1778
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001779tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1780 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001781 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1782 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001783 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001784
1785tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1786 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1787 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1788 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1789 check servers.
1790
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001791tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1792 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1793 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1794 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001795 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001796
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001797tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001798 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1799 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1800 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1801 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1802 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1803 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1804 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1805 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1806 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1807 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001808
1809tune.maxpollevents <number>
1810 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1811 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1812 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1813 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1814 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1815
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001816tune.maxrewrite <number>
1817 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1818 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1819 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1820 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1821 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1822 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1823 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1824 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1825 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1826 bufsize.
1827
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001828tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1829 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1830 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1831 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1832 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1833 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1834 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1835 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1836 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1837 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau7fdd81c2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001838 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1839 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001840 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1841 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1842 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1843 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1844 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1845 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1846 setting this parameter to 0.
1847
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001848tune.pipesize <number>
1849 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1850 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1851 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1852 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1853 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1854 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1855
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001856tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1857 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1858 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1859 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1860 default is 20.
1861
1862tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1863 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1864 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1865 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1866 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1867 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1868 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001869 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001870
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001871tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1872tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1873 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1874 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1875 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001876 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001877 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001878 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1879 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1880
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001881tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001882 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001883 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1884 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1885 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1886 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1887
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001888tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001889 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001890 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1891 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1892
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001893tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1894tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1895 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1896 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1897 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001898 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001899 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001900 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1901 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1902 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1903 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1904 notifying haproxy again.
1905
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001906tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001907 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1908 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1909 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001910 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001911 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001912 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001913 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1914 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1915 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001916 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1917 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001918
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001919tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001920 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001921 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1922 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1923 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1924 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1925 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1926
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001927tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1928 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001929 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001930 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1931 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1932 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1933 being used for too long.
1934
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001935tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1936 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1937 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1938 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1939 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1940 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1941 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1942 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1943 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1944 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1945 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001946 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001947 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001948
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001949tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1950 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1951 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1952 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1953 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1954 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1955 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1956 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001957 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1958 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001959
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001960tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1961 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1962 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1963 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1964 1000 entries.
1965
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001966tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1967 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1968 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1969 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1970
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001971tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001972tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001973tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1974tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1975tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001976 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1977 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1978 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1979 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1980 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1981 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1982 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1983 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001984
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001985 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1986 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1987 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1988 all available space is consumed.
1989 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1990 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1991 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001992
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001993tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1994 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001995 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001996 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001997 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001998 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1999
2000tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2001 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2002 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002003 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2004 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020063.3. Debugging
2007--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002008
2009debug
2010 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2011 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2012 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2013 system startup.
2014
2015quiet
2016 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2017 line argument "-q".
2018
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020203.4. Userlists
2021--------------
2022It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2023http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2024it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2025
2026userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002027 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002028 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2029
2030group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002031 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002032 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2033 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2034
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002035user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2036 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002037 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2038 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002039 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2040 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2041 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2042 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002043
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002044 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2045 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2046 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2047 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2048 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2049 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2050 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2051 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2052 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002053
2054 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002055 userlist L1
2056 group G1 users tiger,scott
2057 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002058
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002059 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2060 user scott insecure-password elgato
2061 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002062
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002063 userlist L2
2064 group G1
2065 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002066
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002067 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2068 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2069 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002070
2071 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002072
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002073
20743.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002075----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002076It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2077several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2078instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2079values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2080automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2081In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2082using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2083tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2084reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2085Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2086that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2087each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002088
2089peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002090 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002091 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2092
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002093bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2094 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2095 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2096
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002097disabled
2098 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2099 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2100 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2101
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002102default-bind [param*]
2103 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2104
2105default-server [param*]
2106 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2107
2108 Arguments:
2109 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2110 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2111 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2112 details.
2113
2114
2115 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2116
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002117enable
2118 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2119
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002120peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002121 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2122 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2123 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2124 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2125 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2126 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2127
2128 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2129 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2130
2131 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2132 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2133 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2134 across all peers.
2135
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002136 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2137 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002138
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002139 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2140 "server" keyword explanation below).
2141
2142server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002143 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002144 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2145 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2146 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2147 of this "peers" section).
2148 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2149
2150
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002151 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002152 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002153 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002154 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2155 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2156 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002157
2158 backend mybackend
2159 mode tcp
2160 balance roundrobin
2161 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2162 stick on src
2163
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002164 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2165 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002166
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002167 Example:
2168 peers mypeers
2169 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2170 default-server ssl verify none
2171 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2172 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002173
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002174
2175table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2176 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2177
2178 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2179 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002180 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002181 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2182 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2183 "stick-table" keyword).
2184
2185 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2186 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2187 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2188 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2189 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2190 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2191 of the stick-table name as follows:
2192
2193 peers mypeers
2194 peer A ...
2195 peer B ...
2196 table t1 ...
2197
2198 frontend fe1
2199 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2200
2201 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2202 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2203
2204 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2205 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2206 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2207 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2208 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2209 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2210 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2211
2212 peers mypeers
2213 peer A ...
2214 peer B ...
2215 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2216
2217 backend t1
2218 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2219
2220 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2221 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2222 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2223
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022243.6. Mailers
2225------------
2226It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2227If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2228in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2229
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002230mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002231 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2232 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2233
2234mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2235 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2236
2237 Example:
2238 mailers mymailers
2239 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2240 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2241
2242 backend mybackend
2243 mode tcp
2244 balance roundrobin
2245
2246 email-alert mailers mymailers
2247 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2248 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2249
2250 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2251 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2252
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002253timeout mail <time>
2254 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2255 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2256 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2257 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2258
2259 Example:
2260 mailers mymailers
2261 timeout mail 20s
2262 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002263
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022643.7. Programs
2265-------------
2266In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2267master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2268managed the same way as the workers.
2269
2270During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2271sequence as a worker:
2272
2273 - the master is re-executed
2274 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2275 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2276 instance of the program
2277
2278During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2279
2280program <name>
2281 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2282 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2283 the management guide).
2284
2285command <command> [arguments*]
2286 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2287 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2288 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2289 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2290
2291option start-on-reload
2292no option start-on-reload
2293 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2294 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2295 program section.
2296
2297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022984. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002299----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002300
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002301Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002302 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002303 - frontend <name>
2304 - backend <name>
2305 - listen <name>
2306
2307A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2308its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2309section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002310section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002311
2312A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2313connections.
2314
2315A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2316to forward incoming connections.
2317
2318A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2319parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2320
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002321All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2322'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2323case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2324
2325Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2326logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2327proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2328However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2329name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2330
2331Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2332and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002333bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002334protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2335modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2336arbitrary criteria.
2337
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002338In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2339a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto599788e2019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002340the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002341
2342 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2343 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2344 between responses and new requests.
2345
2346 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2347 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2348 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002349 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2350 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2351 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2352 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002353
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002354 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2355 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2356 client-facing connection remains open.
2357
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002358 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2359 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002360
2361The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2362frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2363following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002364weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002365
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002366 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002367
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002368 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2369 ----+-----+-----+----
2370 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2371 ----+-----+-----+----
2372 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2373 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2374 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2375 ----+-----+-----+----
2376 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002377
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002378
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023804.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2381--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002383The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2384limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2385they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2386limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002387marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002388option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002389and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2390with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2391specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002392
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002393
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002394 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2395------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2396acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002397backlog X X X -
2398balance X - X X
2399bind - X X -
2400bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002401block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002402capture cookie - X X -
2403capture request header - X X -
2404capture response header - X X -
2405clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002406compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002407contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2408cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002409declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002410default-server X - X X
2411default_backend X X X -
2412description - X X X
2413disabled X X X X
2414dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002415email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002416email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002417email-alert mailers X X X X
2418email-alert myhostname X X X X
2419email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002420enabled X X X X
2421errorfile X X X X
2422errorloc X X X X
2423errorloc302 X X X X
2424-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2425errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002426force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002427filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002428fullconn X - X X
2429grace X X X X
2430hash-type X - X X
2431http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002432http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002433http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002434http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002435http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002436http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002437http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002438id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002439ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002440load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002441log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002442log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002443log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002444log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002445max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002446maxconn X X X -
2447mode X X X X
2448monitor fail - X X -
2449monitor-net X X X -
2450monitor-uri X X X -
2451option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2452option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2453option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2454option allbackups (*) X - X X
2455option checkcache (*) X - X X
2456option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2457option contstats (*) X X X -
2458option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2459option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002460-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2461option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002462option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2463option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002464option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002465option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002466option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002467option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002468option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002469option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002470option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002471option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002472option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002473option httpchk X - X X
2474option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002475option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002476option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002477option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002478option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002479option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002480option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2481option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2482option logasap (*) X X X -
2483option mysql-check X - X X
2484option nolinger (*) X X X X
2485option originalto X X X X
2486option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002487option pgsql-check X - X X
2488option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002489option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002490option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002491option smtpchk X - X X
2492option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2493option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2494option splice-request (*) X X X X
2495option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002496option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002497option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2498option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2499-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002500option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002501option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2502option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2503option tcpka X X X X
2504option tcplog X X X X
2505option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002506external-check command X - X X
2507external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002508persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2509rate-limit sessions X X X -
2510redirect - X X X
2511redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2512redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002513reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2514reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2515reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2516reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2517reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2518reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2519reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2520reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2521reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2522reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2523reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2524reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002525-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002526reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002527retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002528retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002529rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2530rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2531rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2532rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2533rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2534rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2535rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002536server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002537server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002538server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002539source X - X X
2540srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002541stats admin - X X X
2542stats auth X X X X
2543stats enable X X X X
2544stats hide-version X X X X
2545stats http-request - X X X
2546stats realm X X X X
2547stats refresh X X X X
2548stats scope X X X X
2549stats show-desc X X X X
2550stats show-legends X X X X
2551stats show-node X X X X
2552stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002553-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2554stick match - - X X
2555stick on - - X X
2556stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002557stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002558stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002559tcp-check connect - - X X
2560tcp-check expect - - X X
2561tcp-check send - - X X
2562tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002563tcp-request connection - X X -
2564tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002565tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002566tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002567tcp-response content - - X X
2568tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002569timeout check X - X X
2570timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002571timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002572timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2573timeout connect X - X X
2574timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2575timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2576timeout http-request X X X X
2577timeout queue X - X X
2578timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002579timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2581timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002582timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002583transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002584unique-id-format X X X -
2585unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002586use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002587use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002588------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2589 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025924.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2593---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002594
2595This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2596
2597
2598acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2599 Declare or complete an access list.
2600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2601 no | yes | yes | yes
2602 Example:
2603 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2604 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2605 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002607 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
2609
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002610backlog <conns>
2611 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2613 yes | yes | yes | no
2614 Arguments :
2615 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2616 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002617 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002618
2619 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2620 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2621 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2622 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2623 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2624 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2625 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2626 backlog parameter.
2627
2628 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2629 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2630 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2631
2632 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2633
2634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002635balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002636balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2639 yes | no | yes | yes
2640 Arguments :
2641 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2642 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2643 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2644 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2645
2646 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2647 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2648 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2649 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002650 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002651 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002652 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2653 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2654 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2655 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2656 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2657 it, so that you don't worry.
2658
2659 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2660 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2661 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2662 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2663 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2664 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2665 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2666 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002667
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002668 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2669 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2670 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2671 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2672 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2673 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2674 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2675 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2676
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002677 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002678 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002679 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2680 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002681 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002682 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2683 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2684 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2685 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2686 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002687 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2688 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2689 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2690 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2691 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2692 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002693
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002694 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2695 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2696 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2697 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2698 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2699 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2700 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2701 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002702 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002703 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002704 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2705 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2706 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002708 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2709 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2710 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2711 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2712 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2713 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2714 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2715 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2716 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2717 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2718 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2719 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002720
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002721 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002722 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2723 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2724 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2725 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2726 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2727 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2728 URIs start with a leading "/".
2729
2730 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2731 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2732 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2733 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2734
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002735 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002736 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2737
2738 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002739 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2740 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002741 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2742 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2743 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2744 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002745 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002746 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2747 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002748
2749 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2750 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2751 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2752 server will receive the request.
2753
2754 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2755 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2756 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2757 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2758 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002759 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2760 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2761 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002762
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002763 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2764 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2765 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2766 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2767 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002769 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002770 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2771 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2772 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2773
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002774 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2775 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2776 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2777
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002778 random
2779 random(<draws>)
2780 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002781 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2782 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2783 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2784 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002785 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2786 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2787 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2788 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2789 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2790 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2791 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2792 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2793 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2794 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2795 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2796 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2797 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2798 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2799 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2800 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2801 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2802 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2803 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2804 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002805
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002806 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002807 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002808 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2809 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2810 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2811 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2812 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2813 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002814 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002815 used instead.
2816
2817 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2818 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2819 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2820 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2821
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002822 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2823 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2824 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2825
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002826 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002827
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002829 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2830 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002831
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002832 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2833 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2834 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002835
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002836 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002837 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002838 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2839 NTLM relies on.
2840
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841 Examples :
2842 balance roundrobin
2843 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002844 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002845 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2846 balance hdr(host)
2847 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002848
2849 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2850 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002852 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002853 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2854 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2855 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2856 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2857
2858 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2859 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2860 defaults to 16 kB.
2861
2862 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2863 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2864
2865 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2866 Round Robin.
2867
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002868 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002869 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2870 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2871 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2872
2873 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2874
2875 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002876 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002877 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2878 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2879 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002880
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002881 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002882
2883
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002884bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2885bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002886 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2888 no | yes | yes | no
2889 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002890 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2891 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2892 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2893 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002894 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002895 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2896 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2897 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2898 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2899 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2900 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2901 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002902 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2903 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2904 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2905 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2906 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2907 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2908 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002909 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2910 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2911 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002912 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2913 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2914 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2915 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002916 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2917 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2918 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002919
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002920 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2921 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002922 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2923 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2924 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002925 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2926 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2927 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2928 the range.
2929
2930 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2931 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2932 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2933 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2934 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2935 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2936 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002937 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002938 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002939
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002940 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002941 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002942 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2943 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2944 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2945 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2946 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2947 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2948
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002949 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2950 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2951 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2952 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002953
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2955 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2956 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2957 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2958 in a frontend.
2959
2960 Example :
2961 listen http_proxy
2962 bind :80,:443
2963 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002964 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002965
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002966 listen http_https_proxy
2967 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002968 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002969
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002970 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2971 bind ipv6@:80
2972 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2973 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2974
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002975 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002976 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002977
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002978 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2979 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2980 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2981 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2982 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2983
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002984 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002985 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002986
2987
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002988bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002989 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2991 yes | yes | yes | yes
2992 Arguments :
2993 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2994 may be used to override a default value.
2995
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002996 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002997 option may be combined with other numbers.
2998
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002999 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003000 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3001 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3002 missing from all processes.
3003
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003004 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003005 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003006 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3007 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3008 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3009 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3010 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003011 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003012
3013 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3014 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3015 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3016 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3017 and 'even' instances.
3018
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003019 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3020 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3021 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3022 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003023
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003024 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3025 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3026
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003027 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3028 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3029 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3030
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003031 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3032 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3033
3034 Example :
3035 listen app_ip1
3036 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003037 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003038
3039 listen app_ip2
3040 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003041 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003042
3043 listen management
3044 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003045 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003046
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003047 listen management
3048 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3049 bind-process 1-4
3050
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003051 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003052
3053
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003054block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003055 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
3056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3057 no | yes | yes | yes
3058
3059 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
3060 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003061 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003062 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003063 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003064 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
3065 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
3066 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003067
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003068 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
3069 "http-request deny" instead.
3070
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003071 Example:
3072 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3073 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3074 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03003075 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
3076 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
3077 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003078
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003079 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
3080 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
3081 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003082
3083capture cookie <name> len <length>
3084 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3086 no | yes | yes | no
3087 Arguments :
3088 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3089 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3090 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3091 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003092 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003093
3094 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3095 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3096 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3097 right if it exceeds <length>.
3098
3099 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3100 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3101 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3102 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3103
3104 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3105 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3106 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3107
3108 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3109 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3110 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003111 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3112 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3113 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003114
3115 Example:
3116 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3117
3118 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003119 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003120
3121
3122capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003123 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3125 no | yes | yes | no
3126 Arguments :
3127 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003128 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003129 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3130 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3131 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3132
3133 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3134 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3135 it exceeds <length>.
3136
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003137 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3139 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003140 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3141 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3142 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3143 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003144 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003145 environments to find where the request came from.
3146
3147 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3148 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3149 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3150 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003152 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3153 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3154 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3155 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3156 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003157
3158 Example:
3159 capture request header Host len 15
3160 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003161 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003163 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003164 about logging.
3165
3166
3167capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003168 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3170 no | yes | yes | no
3171 Arguments :
3172 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003173 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003174 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3175 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3176 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3177
3178 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3179 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3180 it exceeds <length>.
3181
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003182 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003183 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3184 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3185 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003186 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3187 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3188 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3189 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003190
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003191 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3192 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3193 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3194 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3195 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003196
3197 Example:
3198 capture response header Content-length len 9
3199 capture response header Location len 15
3200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003201 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003202 about logging.
3203
3204
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003205clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3208 yes | yes | yes | no
3209 Arguments :
3210 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3211 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3212 as explained at the top of this document.
3213
3214 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3215 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3216 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3217 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3218 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3219 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3220 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3221 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003222 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003223 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003224 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003225
3226 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3227 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3228 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3229 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3230 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3231 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3232
3233 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3234 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3235
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003236 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3237 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003239compression algo <algorithm> ...
3240compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003241compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003242 Enable HTTP compression.
3243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3244 yes | yes | yes | yes
3245 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003246 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3247 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3248 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3249
3250 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003251 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3252 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3253 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003254
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003255 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003256 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003257
3258 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3259 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3260 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3261 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3262 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003263 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003264
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003265 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3266 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3267 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3268 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3269 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3270 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3271 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003272 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003273
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003274 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003275 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003276 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3277 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3278 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3279 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3280 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003281
3282 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3283 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3284 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3285 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3286 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003287 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3288 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3289 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3290 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3291 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003292 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3293 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003294
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003295 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003296 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3297 "Accept-Encoding" header
3298 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003299 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003300 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3301 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3302 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3303 "multipart"
3304 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3305 header
3306 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3307 and later
3308 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3309 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003310 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003311
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003312 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003313
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003314 Examples :
3315 compression algo gzip
3316 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003317
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003318
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003319contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003320 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3322 yes | no | yes | yes
3323 Arguments :
3324 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3325 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3326 as explained at the top of this document.
3327
3328 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003329 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003330 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003332 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3333 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3334 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3335
3336 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3337 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3338 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3339 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3340 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3341 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3342
3343 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3344 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3345 instead.
3346
3347 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3348 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3349
3350
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003351cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003352 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3353 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003354 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003355 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3357 yes | no | yes | yes
3358 Arguments :
3359 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3360 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3361 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3362 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3363 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3364 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003365 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3367 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3368
3369 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3370 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3371 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3372 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3373 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3374 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003375 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3376 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003377 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003378 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3379 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003380
3381 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003382 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003383
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003384 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003385 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003386 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003387 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003388 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3389 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3390 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3391 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3392 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3393 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3394 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003395
3396 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3397 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3398 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3399 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3400 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3401 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3402 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3403 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3404 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003405 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003406 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3407 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3408 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003409
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003410 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3411 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3412 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003413 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3414 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3415 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3416 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003417 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3418 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3419 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003420
3421 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3422 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3423 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3424 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3425 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3426 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3427 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3428 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3429 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3430
3431 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3432 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3433 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3434 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3435 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3436 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3437 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3438 persistence cookie in the cache.
3439 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3440
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003441 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3442 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3443 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3444 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3445 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003446 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003447 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3448 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3449 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3450 they logout.
3451
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003452 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3453 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3454 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3455 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3456
3457 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3458 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3459 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3460 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3461 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3462 this attribute.
3463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003464 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003465 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003466 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3467 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3468 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3469 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3470 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3471 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003472
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003473 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3474 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3475 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3476 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3477 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3478 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3479 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3480 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003481 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003482 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3483 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3484 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3485 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3486 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3487 the site.
3488
3489 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3490 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3491 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3492 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3493 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3494 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3495 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3496 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3497 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3498 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3499 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3500 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3501 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003502 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003503 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3504 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3505
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003506 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3507 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3508 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3509 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3510 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3511 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3512
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003513 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3514 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3515 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3516 repeated.
3517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003518 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3519 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3520 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3521 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003522
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003523 Examples :
3524 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3525 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3526 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003527 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003528
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003529 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003530
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003531
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003532declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3533 Declares a capture slot.
3534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3535 no | yes | yes | no
3536 Arguments:
3537 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3538
3539 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3540 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3541 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3542 for use in the response.
3543
3544 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003545 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003546 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3547
3548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003549default-server [param*]
3550 Change default options for a server in a backend
3551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3552 yes | no | yes | yes
3553 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003554 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3555 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3556 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3557 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003558
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003559 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003560 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3561
3562 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003563
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003564
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003565default_backend <backend>
3566 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3568 yes | yes | yes | no
3569 Arguments :
3570 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3571
3572 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3573 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3574 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3575 will catch all undetermined requests.
3576
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003577 Example :
3578
3579 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3580 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3581 default_backend dynamic
3582
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003583 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003584
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003585
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003586description <string>
3587 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3589 no | yes | yes | yes
3590 Arguments : string
3591
3592 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3593 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3594 it describes.
3595 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3596
3597
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003598disabled
3599 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3601 yes | yes | yes | yes
3602 Arguments : none
3603
3604 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3605 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3606 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3607 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3608 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3609 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3610 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3611
3612 See also : "enabled"
3613
3614
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003615dispatch <address>:<port>
3616 Set a default server address
3617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3618 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003619 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003620
3621 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3622 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3623 during start-up.
3624
3625 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3626 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3627 possible with normal servers.
3628
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003629 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003630 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3631 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3632 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3633 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3634
3635 See also : "server"
3636
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003637
3638dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3639 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3641 yes | no | yes | yes
3642 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3643
3644 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003645 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003646 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3647 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003648 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003649 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003650
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003651enabled
3652 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3654 yes | yes | yes | yes
3655 Arguments : none
3656
3657 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3658 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3659
3660 See also : "disabled"
3661
3662
3663errorfile <code> <file>
3664 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3666 yes | yes | yes | yes
3667 Arguments :
3668 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003669 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3670 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003671
3672 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003673 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003674 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003675 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3676 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003677
3678 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3679 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3680 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3681
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003682 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3683
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003684 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3685 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3686 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3687 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3688
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003689 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3690 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003691 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003692 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3693 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3694 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003696 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3697 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3698 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003699 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003700 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3701
3702 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3703
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003704 Example :
3705 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003706 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003707 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3708 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3709
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003710
3711errorloc <code> <url>
3712errorloc302 <code> <url>
3713 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3715 yes | yes | yes | yes
3716 Arguments :
3717 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003718 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3719 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003720
3721 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3722 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3723 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3724 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003725 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003726
3727 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3728 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3729 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3730
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003731 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3732
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003733 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3734 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3735 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3736 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003737 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003738 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3739 request.
3740
3741 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3742
3743
3744errorloc303 <code> <url>
3745 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3747 yes | yes | yes | yes
3748 Arguments :
3749 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003750 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3751 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003752
3753 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3754 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3755 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3756 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003757 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003758
3759 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3760 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3761 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3762
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003763 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3764
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003765 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3766 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3767 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3768 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003769 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003770
3771 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3772
3773
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003774email-alert from <emailaddr>
3775 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003776 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003777 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3778 yes | yes | yes | yes
3779
3780 Arguments :
3781
3782 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3783
3784 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3785 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3786
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003787 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003788 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3789 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003790
3791
3792email-alert level <level>
3793 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3794 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3795 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3796 yes | yes | yes | yes
3797
3798 Arguments :
3799
3800 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3801 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3802 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3803
3804 By default level is alert
3805
3806 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3807 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3808 for the proxy.
3809
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003810 Alerts are sent when :
3811
3812 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3813 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3814 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3815 is notice or lower
3816 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3817 and a health check status update occurs
3818
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003819 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3820 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003821 section 3.6 about mailers.
3822
3823
3824email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3825 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3826 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3827 yes | yes | yes | yes
3828
3829 Arguments :
3830
3831 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3832
3833 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3834 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3835
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003836 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3837 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003838
3839
3840email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3841 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3842 mailers.
3843 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3844 yes | yes | yes | yes
3845
3846 Arguments :
3847
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003848 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003849
3850 By default the systems hostname is used.
3851
3852 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3853 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3854 for the proxy.
3855
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003856 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3857 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003858
3859
3860email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003861 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003862 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3863 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3864 yes | yes | yes | yes
3865
3866 Arguments :
3867
3868 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3869
3870 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3871 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3872
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003873 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003874 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3875
3876
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003877force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3878 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003880 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003881
3882 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3883 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3884 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3885 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3886 marked down for maintenance operations.
3887
3888 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3889 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3890 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3891 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3892 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3893 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3894 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3895 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3896 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3897
3898 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3899 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3900 is used.
3901
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003902 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003903 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003904
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003905
3906filter <name> [param*]
3907 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3909 no | yes | yes | yes
3910 Arguments :
3911 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3912 referenced in section 9.
3913
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003914 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003915 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003916 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3917 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003918
3919 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3920 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3921
3922 Example:
3923 listen
3924 bind *:80
3925
3926 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3927 filter compression
3928 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3929
3930 compression algo gzip
3931 compression offload
3932
3933 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3934
3935 See also : section 9.
3936
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003937
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003938fullconn <conns>
3939 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3941 yes | no | yes | yes
3942 Arguments :
3943 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3944 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3945
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003946 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003947 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003948 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003949 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3950 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3951 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3952 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3953 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003954 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003955
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003956 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3957 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003958 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3959 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3960 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003961
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003962 Example :
3963 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3964 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3965 # connections.
3966 backend dynamic
3967 fullconn 10000
3968 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3969 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3970
3971 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3972
3973
3974grace <time>
3975 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003977 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003978 Arguments :
3979 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3980 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3981 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3982
3983 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3984 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003985 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003986 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3987
3988 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3989 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3990 simplify it.
3991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003992
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003993hash-balance-factor <factor>
3994 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3996 yes | no | no | yes
3997 Arguments :
3998 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3999 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004000 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004001
4002 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4003 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4004 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4005 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4006 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4007 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4008 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4009
4010 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4011 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4012 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4013 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4014 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4015
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004016 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4017 consistent hashing mechanism.
4018
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004019 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4020
4021
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004022hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004023 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4025 yes | no | yes | yes
4026 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004027 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4028 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004029
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004030 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4031 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4032 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4033 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4034 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4035 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4036 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4037 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4038 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4039 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004040
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004041 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4042 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4043 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4044 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4045 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4046 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4047 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4048 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4049 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4050 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4051 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4052 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4053 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004054 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4055 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004056
4057 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4058
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004059 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004060 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4061 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4062 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004063 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4064 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4065 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004066
4067 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4068 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004069 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4070 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4071 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4072 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4073
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004074 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4075 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4076 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4077 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4078 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4079 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4080 parameter.
4081
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004082 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4083 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4084 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4085 used on strings.
4086
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004087 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4088
4089 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4090 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4091 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4092 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4093 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4094 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4095 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4096 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4097 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4098 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4099 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4100 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004101
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004102 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4103 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4104 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004105
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004106 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004107
4108
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004109http-check disable-on-404
4110 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004112 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004113 Arguments : none
4114
4115 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4116 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4117 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4118 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4119 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4120 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4121 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4122 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004123 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4124 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4125 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4126
4127 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4128
4129
4130http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004131 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004133 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004134 Arguments :
4135 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4136 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004137 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004138 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4139 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4140 details on the supported keywords.
4141
4142 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4143 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4144 with the usual backslash ('\').
4145
4146 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4147 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4148 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4149 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4150 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4151
4152 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004153 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004154 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4155 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4156 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4157
4158 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004159 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004160 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4161 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4162 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4163 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4164
4165 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004166 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004167 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4168 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4169 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4170 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4171 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004172 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004173 trace).
4174
4175 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004176 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004177 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4178 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4179 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4180 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4181 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004182 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004183
4184 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4185 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4186 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4187 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4188 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4189 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4190 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4191 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4192
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004193 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4194 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4195 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4196
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004197 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4198 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4199
4200 Examples :
4201 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004202 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004203
4204 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004205 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004206
4207 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004208 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004209
4210 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004211 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004212
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004213 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004214
4215
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004216http-check send [hdr <name> <value>]* [body <string>]
4217 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4218 health checks.
4219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4220 yes | no | yes | yes
4221 Arguments :
4222 hdr <name> <value> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4223 <name> and whose value is defined by <value> to the
4224 request sent during HTTP health checks.
4225
4226 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent
4227 sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4228 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added
4229 to the request.
4230
4231 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4232 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4233 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
4234 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. The old trick consisting to
4235 add headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
4236 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4237 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4238 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4239
4240 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect"
4241
4242
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004243http-check send-state
4244 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4246 yes | no | yes | yes
4247 Arguments : none
4248
4249 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4250 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4251 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4252 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4253 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4254
4255 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4256 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4257 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4258 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4259 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004260 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4261 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4262 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4263
4264 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4265 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4266 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4267
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004268 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4269 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4270 checked in multiple backends.
4271
4272 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4273 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4274
4275 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4276 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4277 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4278 one fails.
4279
4280 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4281 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4282 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4283
4284 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4285 server's queue.
4286
4287 Example of a header received by the application server :
4288 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4289 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4290
4291 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4292
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004293
4294http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004295 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4296
4297 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4298 no | yes | yes | yes
4299
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004300 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4301 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4302 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4303 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4304 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004306 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4307 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004311 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4312 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4313 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4314 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004316 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4317 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4318 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4319 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004321 Example:
4322 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4323 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4324 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004326 http-request allow if nagios
4327 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4328 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4329 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004331 Example:
4332 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4333 acl add path /addacl
4334 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004335
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004336 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004338 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4339 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004340
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004341 Example:
4342 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4343 acl setmap path /setmap
4344 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004346 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004348 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4349 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004351 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4352 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004353
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004354http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004356 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4357 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4358 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4359 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4360 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4361 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4362 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4363 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004365http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004367 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4368 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4369 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4370 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4371 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4372 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4373 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4374 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004376http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004378 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4379 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004380
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004381
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004382http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4385 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4386 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4387 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4388 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004389
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004390 Example:
4391 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4392 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004393
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004394http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004396 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004397
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004398http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4399 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004400
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004401 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4402 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4403 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4404 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4405 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4406 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4407 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4408 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4409 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004410
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004411 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4412 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4413 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004414 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4415
4416 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4417 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4418 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4419 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004420
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004421http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004422
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004423 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4424 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4425 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4426 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4427 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4428 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004429
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004430http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004431
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004432 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004433
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004434http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004435
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004436 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4437 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4438 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4439 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4440 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4441 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004442
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004443http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004444
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004445 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4446 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4447 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4448 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4449 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004450
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004451http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4452 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4453 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4454 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4455
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004456http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4457
4458 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4459 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4460 pointed by <resolvers>.
4461 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4462 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4463 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4464 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4465 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4466 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4467 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4468 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4469 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4470 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4471 to 0.0.0.0.
4472
4473 Example:
4474 resolvers mydns
4475 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4476 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4477 timeout retry 1s
4478 hold valid 10s
4479 hold nx 3s
4480 hold other 3s
4481 hold obsolete 0s
4482 accepted_payload_size 8192
4483
4484 frontend fe
4485 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4486 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4487 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4488
4489 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4490 # which mean DNS resolution error
4491 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4492
4493 default_backend be
4494
4495 backend b_503
4496 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4497 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4498 # 503 error page to end users
4499
4500 backend be
4501 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4502 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4503 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4504 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4505 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4506
4507 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4508 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4509
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004510http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4511
4512 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4513 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4514 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4515 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004516 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4517 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004518
4519 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4520
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004521http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004522
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004523 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4524 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4525 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4526 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4527 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004528
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004529http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004530
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004531 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4532 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4533 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4534 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004535
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004536http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4537 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004538
Ilya Shipitsin5c836fd2020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004539 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004540 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4541 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4542 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4543 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4544 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004545
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004546 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4547 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4548 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4549 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4550 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004551
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004552 Example:
4553 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4554
4555 # applied to:
4556 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4557
4558 # outputs:
4559 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4560
4561 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004562
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004563 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4564
4565 # applied to:
4566 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004567
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004568 # outputs:
4569 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004570
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004571http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4572 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4573
4574 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4575 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4576 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4577 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4578
4579 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4580 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4581 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4582
4583 Example:
4584 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4585 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4586
4587 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4588 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4589
4590 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4591 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4592 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4593 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4594
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004595http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4596 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4597
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004598 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4599 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4600 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4601 against.
4602
4603 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4604 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4605 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004606
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004607 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4608 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4609 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4610 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4611 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4612 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4613 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4614 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4615 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004616 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4617 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004618
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004619 Example:
4620 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4621 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004622
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004623 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4624 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004626http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4627 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004628
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004629 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4630 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4631 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4632 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004633
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004634 Example:
4635 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004636
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004637 # applied to:
4638 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004639
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004640 # outputs:
4641 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004643http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4644http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004646 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4647 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4648 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004650http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004652 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4653 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4654 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004656http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004657
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004658 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4659 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4660 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4661 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4662 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004664 Arguments:
4665 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4666 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004667
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004668 Example:
4669 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4670 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004672 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4673 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004674
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004675http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004677 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4678 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4679 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004680
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004681 Arguments:
4682 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4683 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004684
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004685 Example:
4686 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4687 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004688
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004689 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4690 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4691 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004693http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004694
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004695 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4696 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4697 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4698 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4699 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004700
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004701 Example:
4702 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4703 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4704 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4705 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4706 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4707 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4708 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4709 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4710 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004711
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004712http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004713
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004714 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4715 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4716 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4717 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4718 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004720http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4721 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004722
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004723 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4724 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4725 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4726 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4727 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4728 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4729 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4730 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4731 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004732
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004733http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004734
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004735 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4736 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4737 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4738 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4739 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4740 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4741 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004742
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004743http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004744
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004745 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4746 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4747 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004748
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004749http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004750
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004751 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4752 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4753 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4754 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4755 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4756 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4757 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4758 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004759
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004760http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004761
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004762 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4763 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4764 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4765 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4766 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4767 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004769 Example :
4770 # prepend the host name before the path
4771 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004772
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004773http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004774
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004775 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4776 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4777 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4778 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4779 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004780
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004781http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004782
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004783 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4784 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4785 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4786 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4787 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4788 values have higher priority.
4789 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4790 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4791 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4792 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4793 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004794
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004795http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004796
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004797 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4798 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4799 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4800 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4801 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4802 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4803 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004804
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004805 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004806
4807 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004808 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4809 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004810
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004811http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4812 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4813 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4814 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004815 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
4816 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004817
4818 Arguments :
4819 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4820 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004821
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004822 See also "option forwardfor".
4823
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004824 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004825 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4826 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4827
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004828 # After the masking this will track connections
4829 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
4830 http-request track-sc0 src
4831
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004832 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4833 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4834
4835http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4836
4837 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4838 expression.
4839
4840 Arguments:
4841 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4842 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004843
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004844 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004845 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4846 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4847
4848 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4849 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4850 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4851
4852http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4853
4854 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4855 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4856 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4857 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4858 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4859 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4860 information from the request.
4861
4862 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4863
4864http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4865
4866 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4867 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4868 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4869 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4870 path and the query string.
4871 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4872
4873http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4874
4875 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4876 inline.
4877
4878 Arguments:
4879 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4880 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4881 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4882 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4883 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4884 (request and response)
4885 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4886 processing
4887 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4888 processing
4889 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4890 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4891 and '_'.
4892
4893 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4894 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004895
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004896 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004897 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004898
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004899http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4900 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004901
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004902 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4903 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4904 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4905 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4906 agent name must be used.
4907
4908 Arguments:
4909 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4910
4911 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4912 configuration.
4913
4914http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4915
4916 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4917 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4918 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4919 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4920 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4921 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4922 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4923 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4924 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4925 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4926 action.
4927 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4928 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4929 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4930 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4931 you fully understand how it works.
4932
4933http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4934
4935 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4936 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4937 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4938 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4939 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4940 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4941 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4942 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4943 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4944 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4945 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4946 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4947 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4948
4949http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4950http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4951http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4952
4953 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4954 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4955 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4956 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4957 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4958 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4959 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4960 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4961 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4962 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4963 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4964 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4965
4966 Arguments :
4967 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4968 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4969 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4970 select which table entry to update the counters.
4971
4972 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4973 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4974 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4975 that table until the session ends.
4976
4977 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4978 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4979 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4980 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4981 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4982 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4983 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4984 useful information.
4985
4986 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4987 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4988 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4989 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4990 checks that make use of it.
4991
4992http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4993
4994 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004995
4996 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004997 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004998
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004999http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5000
5001 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5002 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5003 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5004 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5005 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5006 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5007
5008 Arguments :
5009 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5010
5011 Example:
5012 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005014http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005015
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005016 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5017 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5018 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005019
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005020
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005021http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005022 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5023
5024 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5025 no | yes | yes | yes
5026
5027 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5028 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5029 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5030 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5031 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5032 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005034 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5035 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005036
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005037 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005038
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005039 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
5040 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
5041 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
5042 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005043
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005044 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
5045 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
5046 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
5047 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005048
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005049 Example:
5050 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005052 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005054 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5055 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005056
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005057 Example:
5058 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005059
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005060 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005062 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5063 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005065 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5066 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005068http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005069
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005070 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5071 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5072 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5073 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5074 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5075 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5076 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5077 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005078
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005079http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005080
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005081 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5082 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5083 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5084 example, or to pass some internal information.
5085 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5086 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5087 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005088
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005089http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005090
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005091 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5092 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005093
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005094http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005096 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005097
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005098http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005099
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005100 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5101 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5102 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5103 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5104 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5105 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5106 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005107
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005108 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5109 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5110 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5111 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5112 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005113
5114 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5115 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5116 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5117 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005118
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005119http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005120
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005121 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5122 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5123 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5124 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5125 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5126 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005127
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005128http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005129
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005130 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005131
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005132http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005133
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005134 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5135 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5136 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5137 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5138 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5139 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005140
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005141http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005142
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005143 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
5144 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005145
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005146http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005147
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005148 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5149 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5150 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5151 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5152 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5153 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005154
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005155http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5156 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005157
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005158 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5159 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005160
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005161 Example:
5162 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005163
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005164 # applied to:
5165 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005167 # outputs:
5168 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005169
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005170 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005171
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005172http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5173 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005174
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005175 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
5176 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005177
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005178 Example:
5179 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005181 # applied to:
5182 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005184 # outputs:
5185 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005187http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5188http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005189
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005190 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5191 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5192 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005193
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005194http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005195
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005196 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
5197 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
5198 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005199
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005200http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005201
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005202 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5203 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5204 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5205 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5206 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005207
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005208 Arguments:
5209 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005210
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005211 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5212 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005213
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005214http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005215
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005216 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5217 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5218 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005219
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005220http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5221
5222 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5223 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5224 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5225 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5226 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5227
5228http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5229
5230 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5231 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5232 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5233 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5234 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5235 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5236 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5237 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5238 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5239
5240http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5241
5242 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5243 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5244 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5245 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5246 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5247 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5248 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5249
5250http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5251
5252 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5253 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5254 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5255 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5256 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5257 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5258 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5259 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5260
5261http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5262 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5263
5264 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5265 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5266 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5267 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005268
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005269 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005270 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5271 http-response set-status 431
5272 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5273 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005274
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005275http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005276
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005277 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5278 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5279 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5280 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5281 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5282 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5283 based on some information from the request.
5284
5285 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5286
5287http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5288
5289 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5290 inline.
5291
5292 Arguments:
5293 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5294 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5295 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5296 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5297 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5298 (request and response)
5299 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5300 processing
5301 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5302 processing
5303 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5304 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5305 and '_'.
5306
5307 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5308 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005309
5310 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005311 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005312
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005313http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005314
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005315 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5316 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5317 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5318 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5319 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5320 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5321 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5322 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5323 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5324 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5325 action.
5326 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5327 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5328 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5329 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5330 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005331
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005332http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5333http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5334http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005335
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005336 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5337 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5338 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5339 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5340 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5341 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5342
5343http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5344
5345 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5346 about <var-name>.
5347
5348 Example:
5349 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5350
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005351
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005352http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5353 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5354
5355 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5356 yes | no | yes | yes
5357
5358 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005359 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5360 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5361 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005362
5363 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5364
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005365 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5366 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5367 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5368 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5369 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5370 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5371 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5372 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5373 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5374 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005375
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005376 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5377 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5378 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5379 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5380 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5381 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5382 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5383 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005384
5385 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5386 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5387 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5388 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5389 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5390 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5391 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5392 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005393 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005394 downsides of rare connection failures.
5395
5396 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5397 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5398 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5399 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5400 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5401 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005402 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005403 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5404 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5405 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5406 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5407 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5408
5409 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005410 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5411 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5412 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005413
5414 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005415 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005416
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005417 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5418 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005419
Lukas Tribus79a56932019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005420 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005421
5422 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5423 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5424 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5425
5426 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5427
5428
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005429http-send-name-header [<header>]
5430 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005431 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5432 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005433 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005434 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5435
Willy Tarreaue0e32792019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005436 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5437 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5438 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5439 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5440 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5441 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5442 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5443 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5444 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5445 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5446 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5447 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5448 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5449 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5450 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5451 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005452
5453 See also : "server"
5454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005455id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005456 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5458 no | yes | yes | yes
5459 Arguments : none
5460
5461 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5462 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5463 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005464
5465
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005466ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5467 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5468 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005469 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005470
5471 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5472 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5473 and running).
5474
5475 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5476 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5477 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005478 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005479 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5480
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005481 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5482 "unless" condition is met.
5483
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005484 Example:
5485 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5486 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5487 ignore-persist if url_static
5488
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005489 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5490
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005491load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5492 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5493 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5494 yes | no | yes | yes
5495
5496 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5497 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5498 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005499 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005500 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5501 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5502 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5503 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5504
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005505 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005506 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005507 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005508
5509 Arguments:
5510 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5511 named "server-state-file".
5512
5513 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5514 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5515 name is used as a file name.
5516
5517 none don't load any stat for this backend
5518
5519 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005520 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5521 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5522 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005523 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005524 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005525
5526 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5527 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5528
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005529 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005530
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005531 global
5532 stats socket /tmp/socket
5533 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005534
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005535 defaults
5536 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005537
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005538 backend bk
5539 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5540 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005541
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005542
5543 Then one can run :
5544
5545 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5546
5547 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5548
5549 1
5550 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5551 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5552 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5553
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005554 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005555
5556 global
5557 stats socket /tmp/socket
5558 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5559
5560 defaults
5561 load-server-state-from-file local
5562
5563 backend bk
5564 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5565 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5566
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005567
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005568 Then one can run :
5569
5570 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5571
5572 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5573
5574 1
5575 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5576 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5577 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5578
5579 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5580 "show servers state"
5581
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005582
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005583log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005584log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5585 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005586no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005587 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5589 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005590
5591 Prefix :
5592 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5593 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5594 prefix does not allow arguments.
5595
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005596 Arguments :
5597 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5598 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5599 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5600 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5601 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5602 parameter.
5603
5604 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5605 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5606
5607 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5608 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5609 standard syslog port).
5610
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005611 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5612 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5613 standard syslog port).
5614
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005615 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5616 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5617 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005618 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005619
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005620 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5621 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5622 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5623 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5624 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5625 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5626 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5627 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5628 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5629 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5630 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5631 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5632 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5633 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5634 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5635 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005636 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5637 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005638
5639 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5640 and "fd@2", see above.
5641
5642 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5643 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005644
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005645 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5646 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5647 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5648 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5649 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5650 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5651 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5652 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5653 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5654 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005655 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005656
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005657 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5658 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5659 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5660 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5661 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5662
5663 <sample_size>
5664 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5665 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5666 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5667 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5668 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5669
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005670 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5671 one of the following :
5672
5673 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5674 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5675
5676 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5677 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5678
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005679 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5680 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5681 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5682 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5683 systemd logger consumes.
5684
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005685 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5686 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5687 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5688 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5689
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005690 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5691
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005692 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5693 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5694 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5695
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005696 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5697 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5698 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5699 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005700
5701 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5702 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5703 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005704 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5705 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5706 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5707 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5708 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005709
5710 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5711
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005712 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5713 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5714 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005715
5716 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5717 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5718 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5719 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5720
5721 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5722 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005723
5724 Example :
5725 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005726 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5727 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5728 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005729 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5730 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005731 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005732
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005733
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005734log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005735 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5736 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5737 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005738
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005739 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5740 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5741 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5742 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5743 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005744
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005745 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5746 "option httplog" directives.
5747
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005748log-format-sd <string>
5749 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5750 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5751 yes | yes | yes | no
5752
5753 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5754 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5755 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5756 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5757 which covers the log format string in depth.
5758
5759 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5760 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5761
5762 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5763 log format to "rfc5424".
5764
5765 Example :
5766 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5767
5768
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005769log-tag <string>
5770 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5771 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5772 yes | yes | yes | yes
5773
5774 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5775 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5776 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5777 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5778 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5779 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5780 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5781 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5782 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005783
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005784max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5785 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5786 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5787 yes | no | yes | yes
5788
5789 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5790 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5791 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5792 servers.
5793
5794 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5795 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5796 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5797 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5798 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005799 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005800 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5801 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5802 picking a different server.
5803
5804 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5805 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5806 even if they have to be queued.
5807
5808 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5809 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5810
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005811max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5812 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5813 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5814 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005815
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005816maxconn <conns>
5817 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5819 yes | yes | yes | no
5820 Arguments :
5821 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5822 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5823 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5824 closes.
5825
5826 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5827 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5828 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5829 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005830 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5831 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5832 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5833 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005834
5835 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5836 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5837 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5838
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005839 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5840 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005841
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005842 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5843
5844
5845mode { tcp|http|health }
5846 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5848 yes | yes | yes | yes
5849 Arguments :
5850 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5851 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5852 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5853 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5854
5855 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5856 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5857 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5858 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5859 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5860
5861 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005862 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5863 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5864 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5865 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5866 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5867 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5868 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005869
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005870 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5871 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5872 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005873
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005874 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005875 defaults http_instances
5876 mode http
5877
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005878 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005880
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005881monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005882 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5884 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005885 Arguments :
5886 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5887 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005888 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005889 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5890 backend and its backup.
5891
5892 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5893 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5894 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5895 servers in a list of backends.
5896
5897 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5898 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5899 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5900 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5901 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5902 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5903 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005904 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5905 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005906
5907 Example:
5908 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005909 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005910 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5911 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5912 monitor-uri /site_alive
5913 monitor fail if site_dead
5914
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005915 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005916
5917
5918monitor-net <source>
5919 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5921 yes | yes | yes | no
5922 Arguments :
5923 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5924 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5925 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5926 followed by a mask.
5927
5928 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5929 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005930 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005931 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5932
5933 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5934 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5935 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5936 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005937 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5938 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5939 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005940
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005941 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5942 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5943 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5944 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5945 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5946 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005947
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005948 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5949 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005950
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005951 Example :
5952 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5953 frontend www
5954 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5955
5956 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5957
5958
5959monitor-uri <uri>
5960 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5962 yes | yes | yes | no
5963 Arguments :
5964 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5965 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5966
5967 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5968 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5969 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5970 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5971 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5972 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5973 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5974 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5975
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005976 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5977 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5978 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5979 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5980 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5981 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5982 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5983 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005984
5985 Example :
5986 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5987 frontend www
5988 mode http
5989 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5990
5991 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5992
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005993
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005994option abortonclose
5995no option abortonclose
5996 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5998 yes | no | yes | yes
5999 Arguments : none
6000
6001 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6002 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6003 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6004 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006005 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006006 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6007 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6008 encountered while delivering the response.
6009
6010 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6011 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6012 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6013 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6014 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6015 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006016 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006017 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006018 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006019 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6020 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6021 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6022
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006023 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6024 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006025 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6026 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6027 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6028 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6029 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6030 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006031 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006032
6033 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6034 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6035
6036 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6037
6038
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006039option accept-invalid-http-request
6040no option accept-invalid-http-request
6041 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6043 yes | yes | yes | no
6044 Arguments : none
6045
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006046 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006047 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006048 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006049 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6050 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6051 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6052 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6053 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006054 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6055 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6056 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6057 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006058 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006059 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006060 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6061 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6062 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006063
6064 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6065 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6066 been confirmed.
6067
6068 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6069 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006070 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6071 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006072 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6073
6074 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6075 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6076
6077 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6078 stats socket.
6079
6080
6081option accept-invalid-http-response
6082no option accept-invalid-http-response
6083 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6085 yes | no | yes | yes
6086 Arguments : none
6087
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006088 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006089 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006090 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006091 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6092 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6093 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6094 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6095 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006096 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6097 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6098 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006099
6100 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6101 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6102 been confirmed.
6103
6104 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6105 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6106 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6107 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6108
6109 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6110 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6111
6112 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6113 stats socket.
6114
6115
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006116option allbackups
6117no option allbackups
6118 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6120 yes | no | yes | yes
6121 Arguments : none
6122
6123 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6124 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6125 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6126 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6127 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6128 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6129 order between the backup servers anymore.
6130
6131 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6132 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6133
6134 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6135 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6136
6137
6138option checkcache
6139no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006140 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6142 yes | no | yes | yes
6143 Arguments : none
6144
6145 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6146 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006147 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006148 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6149 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006150 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006151
6152 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006153 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006154 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006155 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6156 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006157 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006158 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006159 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6160 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006161 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006162 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6163 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006164 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006165 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6166 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6167 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6168 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6169 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6170 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6171 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6172 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6173 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6174
6175 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006176 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006177 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006178 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006179 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
6180
6181 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6182 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006183 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006184 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006185
6186 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6187 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6188
6189
6190option clitcpka
6191no option clitcpka
6192 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6194 yes | yes | yes | no
6195 Arguments : none
6196
6197 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6198 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006199 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006200 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6201
6202 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6203 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6204 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6205 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6206
6207 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6208 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6209 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6210 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6211 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6212
6213 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6214
6215 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6216 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6217 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6218
6219 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6220 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6221
6222 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6223
6224
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006225option contstats
6226 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6228 yes | yes | yes | no
6229 Arguments : none
6230
6231 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6232 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6233 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6234 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006235 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6236 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6237 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6238 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6239 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006240
6241
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006242option dontlog-normal
6243no option dontlog-normal
6244 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6246 yes | yes | yes | no
6247 Arguments : none
6248
6249 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6250 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6251 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6252 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6253 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6254 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6255 logged.
6256
6257 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6258 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6259 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006261 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006262 logging.
6263
6264
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006265option dontlognull
6266no option dontlognull
6267 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6269 yes | yes | yes | no
6270 Arguments : none
6271
6272 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6273 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6274 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6275 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6276 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6277 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006278 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6279 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6280 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006281
6282 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006283 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006284 would not be logged.
6285
6286 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6287 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6288
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006289 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6290 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006291
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006292
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006293option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006294 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6296 yes | yes | yes | yes
6297 Arguments :
6298 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6299 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006300 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006301 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006302
6303 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6304 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6305 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6306 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6307 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6308 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6309 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006310 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6311 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6312 possible that the client has already brought one.
6313
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006314 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006315 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006316 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006317 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006318 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006319 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006320
6321 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6322 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6323 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6324 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6325 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6326 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6327 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6328
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006329 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6330 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6331 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6332 are under the control of the end-user.
6333
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006334 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006335 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6336 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006337 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6338 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6339 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006340
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006341 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006342 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6343 frontend www
6344 mode http
6345 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6346
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006347 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6348 backend www
6349 mode http
6350 option forwardfor header X-Client
6351
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006352 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006353 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006354
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006355
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006356option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6357no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6358 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6360 yes | yes | yes | no
6361 Arguments : none
6362
6363 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6364 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6365 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6366 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6367 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6368 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6369 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6370
6371 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6372 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6373 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6374 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6375 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6376 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6377 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6378 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6379 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6380 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6381
6382 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6383
6384 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6385 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6386
6387 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6388 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6389
6390
6391option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6392no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6393 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6395 yes | no | yes | yes
6396 Arguments : none
6397
6398 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6399 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6400 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6401 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6402 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6403 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6404 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6405
6406 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6407 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6408 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6409 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6410 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6411 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6412 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6413 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6414 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6415 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6416
6417 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6418
6419 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6420 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6421
6422 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6423 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6424
6425
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006426option http-buffer-request
6427no option http-buffer-request
6428 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6430 yes | yes | yes | yes
6431 Arguments : none
6432
6433 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6434 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6435 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6436 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6437 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6438 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6439 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6440 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006441 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006442 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6443 default.
6444
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006445 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006446
6447
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006448option http-ignore-probes
6449no option http-ignore-probes
6450 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6452 yes | yes | yes | no
6453 Arguments : none
6454
6455 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6456 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6457 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6458 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6459 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6460 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6461 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6462 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6463 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006464 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6465 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006466 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6467
6468 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6469 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6470 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6471 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6472 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6473 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6474 are often the only way to detect them.
6475
6476 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6477 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6478
6479 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6480
6481
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006482option http-keep-alive
6483no option http-keep-alive
6484 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6486 yes | yes | yes | yes
6487 Arguments : none
6488
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006489 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6490 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006491 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6492 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6493 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6494 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6495 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006496
6497 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6498 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006499 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6500 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6501 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6502 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6503 situations where this option may be useful :
6504
6505 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006506 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006507
6508 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6509 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6510
6511 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6512 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6513 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6514 request.
6515
6516 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6517 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006518 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6519 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6520 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006521
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006522 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6523 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6524 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6525 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6526 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6527 not set.
6528
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006529 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006530 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6531 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006532
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006533 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006534 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006535 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006536
6537
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006538option http-no-delay
6539no option http-no-delay
6540 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6542 yes | yes | yes | yes
6543 Arguments : none
6544
6545 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6546 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6547 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6548 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6549 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6550 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6551 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6552 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6553 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6554 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6555 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6556 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6557 affected.
6558
6559 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6560 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6561 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6562 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6563 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6564 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6565 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6566 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6567 latency environments.
6568
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006569 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6570
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006571
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006572option http-pretend-keepalive
6573no option http-pretend-keepalive
6574 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006576 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006577 Arguments : none
6578
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006579 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006580 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6581 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6582 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6583 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6584 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6585 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6586 consider the response complete.
6587
6588 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6589 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6590 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6591 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006592 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006593 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6594
6595 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6596 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6597 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6598 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6599 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6600 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6601 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6602
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006603 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6604 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6605 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6606 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6607 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6608 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006609
6610 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6611 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6612
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006613 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006614 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006615
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006616
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006617option http-server-close
6618no option http-server-close
6619 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6621 yes | yes | yes | yes
6622 Arguments : none
6623
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006624 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6625 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6626 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6627 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006628 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6629 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6630 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6631 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6632 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6633 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6634 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6635 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6636 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6637 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6638 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006639
6640 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6641 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6642 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6643 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006644 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6645 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006646
6647 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6648 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006649 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6650 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6651 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006652
6653 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6654 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6655
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006656 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6657 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006658
6659
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006660option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6661no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6662 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006664 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006665 Arguments : none
6666
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006667 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6668 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6669 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6670
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006671 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6672 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6673 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6674 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006675 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006676
6677 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006678 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006679 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6680 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6681 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6682 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6683 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6684 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6685 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006686
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006687 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6688 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6689 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6690 backend.
6691
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006692 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6693 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6694
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006695 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6696 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006697
6698
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006699option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006700no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006701 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6703 yes | yes | yes | no
6704 Arguments : none
6705
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006706 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006707 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6708 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6709 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6710 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6711 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6712 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6713
6714 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6715 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006716 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6717 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6718 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006719
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006720 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6721 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6722 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6723 front of an existing proxy.
6724
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006725 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6726
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006727 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006728
6729
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006730option http-use-htx
6731no option http-use-htx
6732 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6734 yes | yes | yes | yes
6735 Arguments : none
6736
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006737 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006738 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006739 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6740 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6741 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6742 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6743 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006744
6745 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6746 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6747 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6748 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006749 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6750 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6751 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6752 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006753
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006754 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6755 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6756 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6757 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6758 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006759
6760 See also : "mode http"
6761
6762
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006763option httpchk
6764option httpchk <uri>
6765option httpchk <method> <uri>
6766option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6767 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6769 yes | no | yes | yes
6770 Arguments :
6771 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6772 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6773 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6774 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6775 ones.
6776
6777 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6778 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6779 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6780
6781 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6782 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6783 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006784 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006785
6786 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6787 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6788 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6789 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6790 the lack of any response.
6791
6792 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6793
6794 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6795 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6796 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6797
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006798 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
6799 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
6800 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
6801 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
6802
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006803 Examples :
6804 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6805 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6806 backend https_relay
6807 mode tcp
Christopher Fauletf304ad32020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006808 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
6809 http-check send hdr Host www
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006810 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6811
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006812 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6813 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6814 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006815
6816
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006817option httpclose
6818no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006819 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6821 yes | yes | yes | yes
6822 Arguments : none
6823
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006824 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6825 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6826 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6827 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006828 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006829
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006830 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6831 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006832 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006833 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6834 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006835
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006836 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6837 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6838 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006839
6840 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6841 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006842 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006843 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6844 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6845 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006846
6847 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6848 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6849
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006850 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006851
6852
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006853option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006854 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006856 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006857 Arguments :
6858 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6859 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6860 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006861 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006862 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006863
6864 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6865 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6866 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6867 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6868 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6869 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6870 ports.
6871
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006872 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6873 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006874
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006875 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6876
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006877 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006878
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006879
6880option http_proxy
6881no option http_proxy
6882 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6884 yes | yes | yes | yes
6885 Arguments : none
6886
6887 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6888 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6889 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6890 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6891 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6892
6893 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6894 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006895 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6896 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006897
6898 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6899 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6900
6901 Example :
6902 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6903 backend direct_forward
6904 option httpclose
6905 option http_proxy
6906
6907 See also : "option httpclose"
6908
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006909
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006910option independent-streams
6911no option independent-streams
6912 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6914 yes | yes | yes | yes
6915 Arguments : none
6916
6917 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6918 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6919 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6920 receive data or not.
6921
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006922 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006923 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6924 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6925 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6926 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6927 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6928 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6929 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6930 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6931 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6932 socket buffers.
6933
6934 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6935 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6936 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6937 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6938 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6939
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006940 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006941 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6942 deprecated.
6943
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006944 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006945
6946
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006947option ldap-check
6948 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6950 yes | no | yes | yes
6951 Arguments : none
6952
6953 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6954 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6955 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6956 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6957
6958 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6959 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6960
6961 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6962 configure it.
6963
6964 Example :
6965 option ldap-check
6966
6967 See also : "option httpchk"
6968
6969
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006970option external-check
6971 Use external processes for server health checks
6972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6973 yes | no | yes | yes
6974
6975 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6976 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6977 command".
6978
6979 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6980
6981 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6982
6983
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006984option log-health-checks
6985no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006986 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6988 yes | no | yes | yes
6989 Arguments : none
6990
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006991 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6992 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6993 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006994
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006995 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6996 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6997 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6998 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6999 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7000
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007001 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007002 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007003
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007004 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7005 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7006 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007007
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007008
7009option log-separate-errors
7010no option log-separate-errors
7011 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7013 yes | yes | yes | no
7014 Arguments : none
7015
7016 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7017 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7018 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7019 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7020 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7021 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7022 provides very important information.
7023
7024 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7025 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7026 error logs.
7027
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007028 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007029 logging.
7030
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007031
7032option logasap
7033no option logasap
Jerome Magnina1d4a732020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007034 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7036 yes | yes | yes | no
7037 Arguments : none
7038
Jerome Magnina1d4a732020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007039 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7040 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7041 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7042 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7043
7044 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7045 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7046 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7047 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7048 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
7049 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transfered
7050 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7051 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7052 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7053 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
7054 transfered.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007055
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007056 Examples :
7057 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7058 mode http
7059 option httplog
7060 option logasap
7061 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7062
7063 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7064 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7065 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7066 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007068 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007069 logging.
7070
7071
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007072option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007073 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7075 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007076 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007077 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7078 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007079 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007080
7081 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7082 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007083 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007084 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7085 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7086 in the MySQL table, like this :
7087
7088 USE mysql;
7089 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7090 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7091
7092 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007093 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007094 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7095 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7096 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7097 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7098 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7099 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7100 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7101
7102 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7103 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007104
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007105 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007106
7107 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7108 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7109 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7110 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007111 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7112 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007113
7114 See also: "option httpchk"
7115
7116
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007117option nolinger
7118no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007119 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007120 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7121 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007122 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007123
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007124 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007125 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7126 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7127 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7128 connections.
7129
7130 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7131 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7132 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7133 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7134 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7135 this too.
7136
7137 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7138 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7139 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7140
7141 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7142 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7143 for servers.
7144
7145 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7146 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7147
7148
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007149option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7150 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7152 yes | yes | yes | yes
7153 Arguments :
7154 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7155 matching <network>
7156 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7157 header name.
7158
7159 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7160 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7161 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7162 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7163 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7164 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7165 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7166 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7167 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7168 possible that the client has already brought one.
7169
7170 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7171 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7172 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7173 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7174 header and requires different one.
7175
7176 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7177 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7178 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7179 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7180 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7181 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7182 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7183
7184 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7185 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7186 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7187 both are defined.
7188
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007189 Examples :
7190 # Original Destination address
7191 frontend www
7192 mode http
7193 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7194
7195 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7196 backend www
7197 mode http
7198 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7199
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007200 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007201
7202
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007203option persist
7204no option persist
7205 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7206 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7207 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007208 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007209
7210 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7211 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7212 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7213 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7214 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7215 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7216 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7217 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7218 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7219 redirected to another valid server.
7220
7221 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7222 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7223
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007224 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007225
7226
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007227option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7228 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7230 yes | no | yes | yes
7231 Arguments :
7232 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7233 PostgreSQL server.
7234
7235 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7236 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7237 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7238 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7239
7240 See also: "option httpchk"
7241
7242
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007243option prefer-last-server
7244no option prefer-last-server
7245 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7246 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7247 yes | no | yes | yes
7248 Arguments : none
7249
7250 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7251 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7252 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7253 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7254 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7255 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7256 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7257 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7258 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007259 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7260 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007261 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7262 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7263 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007264 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7265 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7266 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007267
7268 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7269 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7270
7271 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7272
7273
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007274option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007275option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007276no option redispatch
7277 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7278 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7279 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007280 Arguments :
7281 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7282 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7283 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007284 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007285 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007286 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007287 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7288 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7289 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7290
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007291
7292 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7293 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7294 be able to access the service anymore.
7295
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007296 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7297 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007298
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007299 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007300 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7301 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007302
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007303 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
7304 "redisp" keywords.
7305
7306 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7307 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7308
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007309 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007310
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007311
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007312option redis-check
7313 Use redis health checks for server testing
7314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7315 yes | no | yes | yes
7316 Arguments : none
7317
7318 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7319 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7320 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7321 find the "+PONG" response message.
7322
7323 Example :
7324 option redis-check
7325
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007326 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007327
7328
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007329option smtpchk
7330option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7331 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7333 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007334 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007335 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007336 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007337 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7338
7339 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7340 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7341 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7342
7343 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7344 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7345 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7346 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7347 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7348 dead server.
7349
7350 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7351 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007352 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007353 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7354
7355 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7356 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7357 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7358 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007359 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007360
7361 Example :
7362 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7363
7364 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7365
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007367option socket-stats
7368no option socket-stats
7369
7370 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7372 yes | yes | yes | no
7373
7374 Arguments : none
7375
7376
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007377option splice-auto
7378no option splice-auto
7379 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7381 yes | yes | yes | yes
7382 Arguments : none
7383
7384 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7385 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007386 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007387 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007388 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007389 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7390 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7391 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7392 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7393
7394 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7395 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7396 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7397 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7398 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7399 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7400 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7401 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7402 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7403 keyword.
7404
7405 Example :
7406 option splice-auto
7407
7408 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7409 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7410
7411 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7412 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7413
7414
7415option splice-request
7416no option splice-request
7417 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7419 yes | yes | yes | yes
7420 Arguments : none
7421
7422 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007423 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007424 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7425 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7426 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7427 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7428
7429 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7430
7431 Example :
7432 option splice-request
7433
7434 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7435 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7436
7437 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7438 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7439
7440
7441option splice-response
7442no option splice-response
7443 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7445 yes | yes | yes | yes
7446 Arguments : none
7447
7448 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007449 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007450 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7451 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7452 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7453 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7454
7455 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7456
7457 Example :
7458 option splice-response
7459
7460 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7461 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7462
7463 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7464 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7465
7466
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007467option spop-check
7468 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7470 no | no | no | yes
7471 Arguments : none
7472
7473 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7474 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7475 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7476 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7477
7478 Example :
7479 option spop-check
7480
7481 See also : "option httpchk"
7482
7483
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007484option srvtcpka
7485no option srvtcpka
7486 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7488 yes | no | yes | yes
7489 Arguments : none
7490
7491 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7492 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007493 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007494 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7495
7496 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7497 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7498 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7499 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7500
7501 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7502 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7503 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7504 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7505 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7506
7507 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7508
7509 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7510 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7511 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7512
7513 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7514 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7515
7516 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7517
7518
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007519option ssl-hello-chk
7520 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7522 yes | no | yes | yes
7523 Arguments : none
7524
7525 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7526 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7527 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7528 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7529 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7530 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7531 hello message.
7532
7533 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7534 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7535 messages, which is appreciable.
7536
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007537 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7538 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7539 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007540
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007541 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7542
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007543
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007544option tcp-check
7545 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7546 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7547 yes | no | yes | yes
7548
7549 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7550 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7551
7552 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7553 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7554 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7555
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007556 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007557 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7558 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7559 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7560 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7561 only.
7562
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007563 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007564 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7565 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7566 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7567 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7568
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007569 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007570 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7571 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007572 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007573 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7574 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7575 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7576 the respective protocols.
7577 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007578 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007579
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007580 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7581 script.
7582
7583 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7584 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7585 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7586 The "comment" is of course optional.
7587
7588
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007589 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007590 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007591 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007592 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007593
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007594 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007595 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007596 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007597
7598 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7599 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007600 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007601 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007602 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007603 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007604 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007605 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007606 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7607 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007608 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007609 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7610 tcp-check expect string +OK
7611
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007612 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007613 (send many headers before analyzing)
7614 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007615 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007616 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7617 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7618 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7619 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007620 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007621
7622
7623 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7624
7625
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007626option tcp-smart-accept
7627no option tcp-smart-accept
7628 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7630 yes | yes | yes | no
7631 Arguments : none
7632
7633 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7634 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7635 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7636 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7637 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7638 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7639
7640 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7641 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7642 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7643 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7644
7645 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7646 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7647 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007648 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007649
7650 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7651 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7652 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7653
7654 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7655 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7656 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7657
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007658 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7659
7660
7661option tcp-smart-connect
7662no option tcp-smart-connect
7663 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7665 yes | no | yes | yes
7666 Arguments : none
7667
7668 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7669 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7670 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7671 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7672 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7673
7674 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7675 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7676 complex.
7677
7678 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7679 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7680 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7681
7682 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7683 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7684
7685 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7686
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007687
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007688option tcpka
7689 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7691 yes | yes | yes | yes
7692 Arguments : none
7693
7694 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7695 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007696 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007697 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7698
7699 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7700 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7701 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7702 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7703
7704 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7705 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7706 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7707 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7708 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7709
7710 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7711
7712 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7713 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7714 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7715 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7716 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7717 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7718 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7719 backends.
7720
7721 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7722
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007723
7724option tcplog
7725 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007727 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007728 Arguments : none
7729
7730 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7731 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7732 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7733 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7734 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7735 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7736 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7737 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7738
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007739 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7740
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007741 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007742
7743
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007744option transparent
7745no option transparent
7746 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007748 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007749 Arguments : none
7750
7751 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7752 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7753 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7754 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7755 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7756 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7757 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7758 appropriate server.
7759
7760 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7761 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7762
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007763 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007764 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007765
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007766
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007767external-check command <command>
7768 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7770 yes | no | yes | yes
7771
7772 Arguments :
7773 <command> is the external command to run
7774
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007775 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7776
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007777 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007778
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007779 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7780 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7781 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7782 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7783 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7784 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007785
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007786 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7787
7788 Environment variables :
7789 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7790 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7791
7792 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7793
7794 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7795
7796 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7797 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7798 for a UNIX socket).
7799
7800 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7801
7802 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7803
7804 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7805
7806 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7807
7808 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7809
7810 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7811 socket).
7812
7813 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7814 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7815
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007816 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7817
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007818 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7819 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7820 failed.
7821
7822 Example :
7823 external-check command /bin/true
7824
7825 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7826
7827
7828external-check path <path>
7829 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7831 yes | no | yes | yes
7832
7833 Arguments :
7834 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7835
7836 The default path is "".
7837
7838 Example :
7839 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7840
7841 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7842 "external-check command"
7843
7844
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007845persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007846persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007847 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7849 yes | no | yes | yes
7850 Arguments :
7851 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007852 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7853 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007854
7855 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7856 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007857 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007858 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7859 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7860 forwarded to this server.
7861
7862 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7863 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7864 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007865 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007866 a single "listen" section.
7867
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007868 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7869 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7870 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7871
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007872 Example :
7873 listen tse-farm
7874 bind :3389
7875 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7876 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7877 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7878 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7879 persist rdp-cookie
7880 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007881 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007882 balance rdp-cookie
7883 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7884 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7885
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007886 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7887 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007888
7889
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007890rate-limit sessions <rate>
7891 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7893 yes | yes | yes | no
7894 Arguments :
7895 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7896 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7897
7898 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7899 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7900 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7901 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7902 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7903 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7904
7905 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7906 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7907 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7908 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7909
7910 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7911 listen smtp
7912 mode tcp
7913 bind :25
7914 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007915 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007916
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007917 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7918 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7919 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007920
7921 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7922
7923
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007924redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7925redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7926redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007927 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7929 no | yes | yes | yes
7930
7931 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007932 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007933
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007934 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007935 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007936 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7937 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7938 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007939
7940 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7941 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7942 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7943 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7944 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007945 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7946 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7947 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7948 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007949
7950 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7951 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7952 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7953 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7954 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7955 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007956 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007957 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007958 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7959 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7960 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007961
7962 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007963 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7964 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7965 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007966 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007967 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7968 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7969 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7970 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007971
7972 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007973 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007974
7975 - "drop-query"
7976 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7977 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7978 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7979 with a location-type redirect.
7980
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007981 - "append-slash"
7982 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7983 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7984 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7985 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7986
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007987 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7988 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7989 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7990 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7991 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7992 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7993 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7994
7995 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7996 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7997 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7998 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7999 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8000 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8001 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008002
8003 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8004 acl clear dst_port 80
8005 acl secure dst_port 8080
8006 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008007 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008008 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008009 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8010
8011 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008012 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8013 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8014 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008015 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008016
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008017 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8018 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8019 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8020
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008021 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008022 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008023
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008024 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008025 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8026 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8027 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008029 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008030
8031
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008032redisp (deprecated)
8033redispatch (deprecated)
8034 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8035 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8036 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008037 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008038
8039 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8040 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8041 be able to access the service anymore.
8042
8043 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
8044 redistribute them to a working server.
8045
8046 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
8047 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8048 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008049
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008050 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
8051 "option redispatch" instead.
8052
8053 See also : "option redispatch"
8054
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008055
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008056reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008057 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
8058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8059 no | yes | yes | yes
8060 Arguments :
8061 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8062 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008063 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008064
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008065 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8066 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8067
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008068 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8069 the last header of an HTTP request.
8070
8071 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8072 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8073 responses.
8074
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008075 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
8076 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
8077 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
8078
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008079 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
8080 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008081
8082
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008083reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8084reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008085 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8087 no | yes | yes | yes
8088 Arguments :
8089 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8090 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8091 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8092 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8093 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8094 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
8095 ignores case.
8096
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008097 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8098 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8099
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008100 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8101 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
8102 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8103 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008104 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008105
8106 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8107 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8108
8109 Example :
8110 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
8111 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8112 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8113
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008114 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
8115 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008116
8117
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008118reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8119reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008120 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
8121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8122 no | yes | yes | yes
8123 Arguments :
8124 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8125 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8126 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8127 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8128 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
8129 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
8130
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008131 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8132 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8133
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008134 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
8135 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
8136 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
8137 next servers.
8138
8139 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8140 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8141 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8142
8143 Example :
8144 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
8145 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
8146 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
8147
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008148 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
8149 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008150
8151
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008152reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8153reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008154 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8156 no | yes | yes | yes
8157 Arguments :
8158 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8159 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8160 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8161 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8162 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8163 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
8164 case.
8165
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008166 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8167 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8168
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008169 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8170 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
8171 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8172 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008173 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008174
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008175 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008176 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008177 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008178
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008179 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8180 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8181
8182 Example :
8183 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
8184 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8185 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8186
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008187 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8188 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008189
8190
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008191reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8192reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008193 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
8194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8195 no | yes | yes | yes
8196 Arguments :
8197 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8198 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8199 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8200 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8201 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8202 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
8203 case.
8204
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008205 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8206 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8207
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008208 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8209 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
8210 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
8211 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8212
8213 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8214 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8215
8216 Example :
8217 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
8218 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
8219 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8220 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8221
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008222 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8223 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008224
8225
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008226reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8227reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008228 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
8229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8230 no | yes | yes | yes
8231 Arguments :
8232 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8233 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8234 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8235 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8236 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
8237 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
8238
8239 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8240 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8241 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8242 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008243 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008244
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008245 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8246 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8247
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008248 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
8249 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
8250 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
8251
8252 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8253 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8254 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8255 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
8256 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8257
8258 Example :
8259 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008260 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008261 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
8262 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
8263
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008264 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
8265 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008266
8267
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008268reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8269reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008270 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
8271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8272 no | yes | yes | yes
8273 Arguments :
8274 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8275 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8276 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8277 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8278 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8279 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
8280 ignores case.
8281
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008282 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8283 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8284
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008285 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8286 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008287 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
8288 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
8289 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008290 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
8291 not set.
8292
8293 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
8294 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
8295 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
8296 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
8297 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
8298
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008299 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008300 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008301 # block all others.
8302 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
8303 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
8304
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008305 # block bad guys
8306 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
8307 reqitarpit . if badguys
8308
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008309 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
8310 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008311
8312
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008313retries <value>
8314 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8315 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8316 yes | no | yes | yes
8317 Arguments :
8318 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8319 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8320 default value is 3.
8321
8322 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8323 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8324 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8325
8326 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008327 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8328 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008329
8330 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8331 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8332
8333 See also : "option redispatch"
8334
8335
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008336retry-on [list of keywords]
8337 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8338 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8339 yes | no | yes | yes
8340 Arguments :
8341 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8342 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8343 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8344 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8345
8346 none never retry
8347
8348 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8349 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8350
8351 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8352 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8353 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8354 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8355 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8356 processing the request.
8357
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008358 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8359 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8360 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8361 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8362 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8363 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8364 overflow attack for example).
8365
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008366 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8367 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8368 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8369 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8370 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8371 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8372 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8373 amplify denial of service attacks.
8374
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008375 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8376 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8377 considered to be safe to retry.
8378
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008379 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8380 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8381 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8382 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8383
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008384 all-retryable-errors
8385 retry request for any error that are considered
8386 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8387 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8388 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8389
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008390 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8391 not cumulative.
8392
8393 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8394 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8395 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8396 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8397
8398 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8399 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8400 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8401 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8402 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8403 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8404 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8405 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8406 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8407 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8408 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8409 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8410
8411 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8412 should not use this directive.
8413
8414 The default is "conn-failure".
8415
8416 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8417
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008418rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008419 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8421 no | yes | yes | yes
8422 Arguments :
8423 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8424 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008425 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008426
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008427 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8428 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8429
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008430 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8431 the last header of an HTTP response.
8432
8433 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8434 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8435 responses.
8436
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008437 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8438 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008439
8440
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008441rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8442rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008443 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8445 no | yes | yes | yes
8446 Arguments :
8447 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8448 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8449 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8450 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8451 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8452 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8453 ignores case.
8454
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008455 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8456 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8457
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008458 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8459 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008460 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008461 client.
8462
8463 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8464 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8465 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8466
8467 Example :
8468 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008469 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008470
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008471 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8472 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008473
8474
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008475rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8476rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008477 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8479 no | yes | yes | yes
8480 Arguments :
8481 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8482 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8483 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8484 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8485 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8486 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8487 ignores case.
8488
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008489 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8490 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8491
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008492 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8493 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8494 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8495 case-sensitive.
8496
8497 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008498 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8499 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8500 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008501
8502 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8503 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8504
8505 Example :
8506 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8507 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8508
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008509 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8510 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008511
8512
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008513rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8514rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008515 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8517 no | yes | yes | yes
8518 Arguments :
8519 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8520 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8521 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8522 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8523 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8524 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8525 ignores case.
8526
8527 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8528 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8529 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8530 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008531 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008532
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008533 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8534 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8535
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008536 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8537 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8538 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8539
8540 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8541 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8542 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8543 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8544 are not case-sensitive.
8545
8546 Example :
8547 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8548 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8549
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008550 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8551 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008552
8553
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008554server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008555 Declare a server in a backend
8556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8557 no | no | yes | yes
8558 Arguments :
8559 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008560 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008561 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008562
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008563 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8564 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8565 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8566 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008567 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8568 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8569 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8570 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8571 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008572 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8573 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8574 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8575 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8576 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8577 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8578 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008579 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008580 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8581 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8582 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8583 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8584 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8585 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008586 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8587 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008588 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8589 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008590
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008591 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008592 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8593 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8594 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8595 adding this value to the client's port.
8596
8597 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8598 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008599 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008600
8601 Examples :
8602 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8603 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008604 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008605 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8606 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8607 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008608
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008609 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8610 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8611 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8612 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8613 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8614
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008615 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8616 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008617
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008618server-state-file-name [<file>]
8619 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8620 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8621 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8622 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8623 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8624 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8625
8626 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8627 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8628
8629 global
8630 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8631
Willy Tarreau750bb0c2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008632 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008633 load-server-state-from-file
8634
8635 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8636 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008637
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008638server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8639 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8640 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8642 no | no | yes | yes
8643
8644 Arguments:
8645 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8646
8647 <num | range>
8648 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8649 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8650 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8651 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8652
8653 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8654
8655 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8656
8657 <params*>
8658 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8659 keyword.
8660
8661 Examples:
8662 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8663 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8664 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8665
8666 # or
8667 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8668
8669 # would be equivalent to:
8670 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8671 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8672 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8673
8674
8675
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008676source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008677source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008678source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008679 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8681 yes | no | yes | yes
8682 Arguments :
8683 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8684 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008685
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008686 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008687 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8688 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8689 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8690 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8691 supported prefixes are :
8692 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8693 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8694 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008695 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008696 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8697 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008698
8699 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8700 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008701 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8702 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8703 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008704
8705 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8706 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8707 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8708 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8709 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8710 <addr>.
8711
8712 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8713 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8714 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8715 port.
8716
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008717 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8718 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8719 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8720 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008721 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008722 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8723 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8724 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8725 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8726 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8727 HTTP header.
8728
8729 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8730 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008731 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008732 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8733 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8734 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8735 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8736 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8737 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8738 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8739
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008740 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8741 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8742 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8743 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8744 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8745 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8746
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008747 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8748 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8749 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8750 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8751
8752 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8753 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8754 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8755 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8756 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8757 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8758
8759 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8760 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8761 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8762 there are two methods :
8763
8764 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8765 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8766 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8767 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8768 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8769 of the client ranges may be used.
8770
8771 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8772 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8773 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8774 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8775 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8776 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8777 same session.
8778
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008779 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8780 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8781 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008782 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008783
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008784 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8785
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008786 Examples :
8787 backend private
8788 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8789 source 192.168.1.200
8790
8791 backend transparent_ssl1
8792 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8793 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8794
8795 backend transparent_ssl2
8796 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8797 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8798 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8799
8800 backend transparent_ssl3
8801 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8802 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8803 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8804
8805 backend transparent_smtp
8806 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8807 # with Tproxy version 4.
8808 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8809
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008810 backend transparent_http
8811 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8812 # proxy.
8813 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008815 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008816 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008818
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008819srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8820 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8822 yes | no | yes | yes
8823 Arguments :
8824 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8825 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8826 as explained at the top of this document.
8827
8828 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8829 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8830 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8831 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8832 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8833 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8834 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8835
8836 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8837 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8838 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8839 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8840 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008841 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008842 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008843 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008844
8845 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8846 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8847 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8848 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8849 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8850 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8851
8852 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8853 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8854
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008855 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8856 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008857
8858
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008859stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8860 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008862 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008863
8864 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8865 matched.
8866
8867 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8868 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8869
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008870 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8871 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008872 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008873
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008874 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8875 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8876 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8877 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008878
8879 Example :
8880 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8881 backend stats_localhost
8882 stats enable
8883 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8884
8885 Example :
8886 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8887 backend stats_auth
8888 stats enable
8889 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8890 stats admin if TRUE
8891
8892 Example :
8893 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8894 userlist stats-auth
8895 group admin users admin
8896 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8897 group readonly users haproxy
8898 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8899
8900 backend stats_auth
8901 stats enable
8902 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8903 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8904 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8905 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8906
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008907 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8908 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8909 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008910
8911
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008912stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8913 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008915 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008916 Arguments :
8917 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8918
8919 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8920
8921 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8922 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8923 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8924 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8925 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8926 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8927
8928 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8929 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8930 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008931 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008932
8933 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8934 report using "stats scope".
8935
8936 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8937 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8938 unobvious parameters.
8939
8940 Example :
8941 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8942 backend public_www
8943 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8944 stats enable
8945 stats hide-version
8946 stats scope .
8947 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008948 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008949 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8950 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8951
8952 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8953 backend private_monitoring
8954 stats enable
8955 stats uri /admin?stats
8956 stats refresh 5s
8957
8958 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8959
8960
8961stats enable
8962 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008964 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008965 Arguments : none
8966
8967 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8968 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8969 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8970 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8971 - stats auth : no authentication
8972 - stats scope : no restriction
8973
8974 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8975 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8976 unobvious parameters.
8977
8978 Example :
8979 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8980 backend public_www
8981 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8982 stats enable
8983 stats hide-version
8984 stats scope .
8985 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008986 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008987 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8988 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8989
8990 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8991 backend private_monitoring
8992 stats enable
8993 stats uri /admin?stats
8994 stats refresh 5s
8995
8996 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8997
8998
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008999stats hide-version
9000 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009002 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009003 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009004
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009005 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9006 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9007 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9008 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9009 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9010 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009011
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009012 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9013 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9014 unobvious parameters.
9015
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009016 Example :
9017 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9018 backend public_www
9019 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009020 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009021 stats hide-version
9022 stats scope .
9023 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009024 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009025 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9026 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009027
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009028 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9029 backend private_monitoring
9030 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009031 stats uri /admin?stats
9032 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009033
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009034 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009035
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009036
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009037stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9038 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9039 Access control for statistics
9040
9041 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9042 no | no | yes | yes
9043
9044 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9045 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9046 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9047 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9048 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9049 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9050
9051 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9052 instance.
9053
9054 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9055 about ACL usage.
9056
9057
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009058stats realm <realm>
9059 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009061 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009062 Arguments :
9063 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9064 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9065 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9066
9067 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9068 using a backslash ('\').
9069
9070 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9071 only related to authentication.
9072
9073 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9074 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9075 unobvious parameters.
9076
9077 Example :
9078 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9079 backend public_www
9080 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9081 stats enable
9082 stats hide-version
9083 stats scope .
9084 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009085 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009086 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9087 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9088
9089 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9090 backend private_monitoring
9091 stats enable
9092 stats uri /admin?stats
9093 stats refresh 5s
9094
9095 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9096
9097
9098stats refresh <delay>
9099 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009101 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009102 Arguments :
9103 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9104 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9105 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9106 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9107 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9108 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9109
9110 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9111 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9112 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9113 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9114
9115 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9116 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9117 unobvious parameters.
9118
9119 Example :
9120 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9121 backend public_www
9122 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9123 stats enable
9124 stats hide-version
9125 stats scope .
9126 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009127 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009128 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9129 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9130
9131 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9132 backend private_monitoring
9133 stats enable
9134 stats uri /admin?stats
9135 stats refresh 5s
9136
9137 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9138
9139
9140stats scope { <name> | "." }
9141 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009143 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009144 Arguments :
9145 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9146 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9147 section in which the statement appears.
9148
9149 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9150 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9151 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9152 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9153 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9154 exists.
9155
9156 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9157 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9158 unobvious parameters.
9159
9160 Example :
9161 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9162 backend public_www
9163 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9164 stats enable
9165 stats hide-version
9166 stats scope .
9167 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009168 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009169 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9170 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9171
9172 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9173 backend private_monitoring
9174 stats enable
9175 stats uri /admin?stats
9176 stats refresh 5s
9177
9178 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9179
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009180
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009181stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009182 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009184 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009185
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009186 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009187 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9188
9189 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9190 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9191
9192 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9193 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009194 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009195
9196 Example :
9197 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9198 backend private_monitoring
9199 stats enable
9200 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9201 stats uri /admin?stats
9202 stats refresh 5s
9203
9204 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9205 global section.
9206
9207
9208stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009209 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9211 yes | yes | yes | yes
9212 Arguments : none
9213
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009214 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009215 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9216 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9217 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9218 - IP (socket, server)
9219 - cookie (backend, server)
9220
9221 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9222 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009223 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009224
9225 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9226
9227
9228stats show-node [ <name> ]
9229 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009231 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009232 Arguments:
9233 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9234 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9235
9236 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9237 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009238 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009239
9240 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9241 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9242 unobvious parameters.
9243
9244 Example:
9245 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9246 backend private_monitoring
9247 stats enable
9248 stats show-node Europe-1
9249 stats uri /admin?stats
9250 stats refresh 5s
9251
9252 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9253 section.
9254
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009255
9256stats uri <prefix>
9257 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009259 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009260 Arguments :
9261 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9262 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9263 query string.
9264
9265 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9266 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9267 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9268 possible to reach it in the application.
9269
9270 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009271 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009272 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9273 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9274 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9275 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9276
9277 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9278 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9279 an address or a port to statistics only.
9280
9281 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9282 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9283 unobvious parameters.
9284
9285 Example :
9286 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9287 backend public_www
9288 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9289 stats enable
9290 stats hide-version
9291 stats scope .
9292 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009293 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009294 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9295 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9296
9297 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9298 backend private_monitoring
9299 stats enable
9300 stats uri /admin?stats
9301 stats refresh 5s
9302
9303 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9304
9305
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009306stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9307 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009309 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009310
9311 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009312 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009313 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009314 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009315 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9316
9317 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9318 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9319 the "stick-table" statement.
9320
9321 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9322 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9323 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9324 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9325 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9326
9327 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9328 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9329 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9330 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9331 transformation rules.
9332
9333 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9334 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9335 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9336 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9337 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9338 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9339 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9340
9341 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9342 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9343 ACL based conditions.
9344
9345 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9346 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9347 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9348 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9349
9350 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9351 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9352 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9353 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9354
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009355 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9356 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009357 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009358
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009359 Example :
9360 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9361 # last 30 minutes
9362 backend pop
9363 mode tcp
9364 balance roundrobin
9365 stick store-request src
9366 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9367 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9368 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9369
9370 backend smtp
9371 mode tcp
9372 balance roundrobin
9373 stick match src table pop
9374 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9375 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9376
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009377 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009378 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009379
9380
9381stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9382 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9384 no | no | yes | yes
9385
9386 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9387 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9388 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9389 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9390
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009391 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9392 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009393 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009394
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009395 Examples :
9396 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009397 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009398
9399 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9400 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9401 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9402
9403
9404 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9405 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9406 backend http
9407 mode http
9408 balance roundrobin
9409 stick on src table https
9410 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9411 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9412 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9413
9414 backend https
9415 mode tcp
9416 balance roundrobin
9417 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9418 stick on src
9419 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9420 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9421
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009422 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009423
9424
9425stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9426 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9428 no | no | yes | yes
9429
9430 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009431 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009432 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009433 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009434 server is selected.
9435
9436 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9437 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9438 the "stick-table" statement.
9439
9440 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9441 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9442 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9443 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9444 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9445 address.
9446
9447 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9448 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9449 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9450 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9451 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9452 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9453 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9454 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9455 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9456 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9457
9458 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9459 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9460 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9461 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9462 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9463 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9464 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9465
9466 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9467 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9468 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9469 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9470
9471 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9472 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9473 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9474 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9475 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9476 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009477 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9478 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9479 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9480 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9481 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9482 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009483
9484 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9485 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9486 the request.
9487
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009488 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9489 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009490 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009491
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009492 Example :
9493 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9494 # last 30 minutes
9495 backend pop
9496 mode tcp
9497 balance roundrobin
9498 stick store-request src
9499 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9500 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9501 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9502
9503 backend smtp
9504 mode tcp
9505 balance roundrobin
9506 stick match src table pop
9507 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9508 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9509
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009510 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009511 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009512
9513
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009514stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009515 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9516 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009517 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009519 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009520
9521 Arguments :
9522 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9523 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9524 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9525 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9526
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009527 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9528 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9529 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9530 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9531
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009532 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9533 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9534 instance.
9535
9536 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9537 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9538 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9539 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9540 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9541 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009542 to 32 characters.
9543
9544 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9545 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9546 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009547 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009548 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9549 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009550
9551 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009552 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9553 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009554 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9555 increase.
9556
9557 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009558 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9559 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9560 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009561
9562 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9563 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9564 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9565 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009566 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009567 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9568 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9569 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9570 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9571 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9572 parameter (see below).
9573
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009574 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9575 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9576 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9577 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9578 soft restart.
9579
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009580 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9581 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009582
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009583 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9584 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9585 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9586 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009587 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009588 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009589 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9590 if not expiration delay is specified.
9591
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009592 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9593 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9594 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9595 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009596 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9597 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9598 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9599 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9600 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9601 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9602 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9603 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9604 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9605 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9606 types and their arguments.
9607
9608 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9609 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9610 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9611 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9612
9613 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9614 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9615 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009616 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009617
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009618 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9619 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9620 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009621 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009622 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009623 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009624
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009625 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9626 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9627 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9628 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9629
9630 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9631 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9632 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9633 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9634 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9635 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9636
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009637 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9638 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9639 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9640 they were received.
9641
9642 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9643 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9644 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9645 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9646 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9647
9648 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9649 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9650 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9651 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9652 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9653
9654 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9655 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9656 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9657
9658 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9659 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9660 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9661 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9662 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9663
9664 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9665 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9666 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9667 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9668 the client side.
9669
9670 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9671 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9672 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9673 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9674 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9675 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9676 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9677
9678 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9679 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9680 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9681 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9682 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9683 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009684 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009685
9686 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9687 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9688 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9689 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9690 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9691 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9692
9693 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009694 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009695 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9696 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9697
9698 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9699 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9700 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9701 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9702 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9703 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9704 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9705 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9706 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9707 recommended for better fairness.
9708
9709 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009710 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009711 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9712 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9713
9714 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9715 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9716 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9717 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9718 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9719 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9720 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9721 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9722 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9723 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009724
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009725 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9726 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009727 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9728 reference it.
9729
9730 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9731 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009732 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9733 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9734 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009735
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009736 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9737 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9738 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9739 something that can be ignored.
9740
9741 Example:
9742 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9743 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9744 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9745 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9746
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009747 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009748 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009749
9750
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009751stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009752 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9754 no | no | yes | yes
9755
9756 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009757 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009758 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009759 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009760 server is selected.
9761
9762 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9763 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9764 the "stick-table" statement.
9765
9766 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9767 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9768 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9769 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9770
9771 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9772 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9773 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9774 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9775 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9776 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009777 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009778 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9779 rules.
9780
9781 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9782 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9783 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9784 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9785 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9786 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9787 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9788
9789 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9790 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9791 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9792 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9793
9794 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9795 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9796 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9797 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9798 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9799 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009800 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9801 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9802 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9803 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9804 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9805 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9806 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9807 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9808 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009809
9810 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9811
9812 Example :
9813 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9814 backend https
9815 mode tcp
9816 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009817 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009818 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009819
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009820 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9821 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9822
9823 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9824 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9825 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9826
9827 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9828 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009829
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009830 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9831 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9832 # at offset 44.
9833
9834 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9835 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9836
9837 # Learn on response if server hello.
9838 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009839
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009840 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9841 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9842
9843 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9844 extraction.
9845
9846
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009847tcp-check connect [params*]
9848 Opens a new connection
9849 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9850 no | no | yes | yes
9851
9852 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9853 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9854 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9855
9856 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9857 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9858 of the sequence.
9859
9860 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9861 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9862 do.
9863
9864 Parameters :
9865 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9866 use the TCP connection.
9867
9868 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9869 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9870 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9871
9872 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9873
9874 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9875
9876 Examples:
9877 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9878 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9879 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9880 option tcp-check
9881 tcp-check connect
9882 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9883 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9884 tcp-check send \r\n
9885 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9886 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9887 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9888 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9889 tcp-check send \r\n
9890 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9891 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9892
9893 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9894 option tcp-check
9895 tcp-check connect port 110
9896 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9897 tcp-check connect port 143
9898 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9899 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9900
9901 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9902
9903
9904tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009905 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009906 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9907 no | no | yes | yes
9908
9909 Arguments :
9910 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9911 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9912 binary.
9913 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9914 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9915 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9916
9917 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9918 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9919 with the usual backslash ('\').
9920 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009921 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009922 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9923 used upper or lower case.
9924
9925
9926 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9927
9928 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9929 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9930 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9931 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9932 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9933 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9934 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9935 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9936
9937 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9938 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9939 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9940 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9941 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9942 expression.
9943
9944 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9945 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9946 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9947 this exact hexadecimal string.
9948 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9949
9950 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9951 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9952 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9953 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9954 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9955 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9956 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9957 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9958 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9959 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9960 the null character.
9961
9962 Examples :
9963 # perform a POP check
9964 option tcp-check
9965 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9966
9967 # perform an IMAP check
9968 option tcp-check
9969 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9970
9971 # look for the redis master server
9972 option tcp-check
9973 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009974 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009975 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9976 tcp-check expect string role:master
9977 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9978 tcp-check expect string +OK
9979
9980
9981 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9982 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9983
9984
9985tcp-check send <data>
9986 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9987 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9988 no | no | yes | yes
9989
9990 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9991 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9992
9993 Examples :
9994 # look for the redis master server
9995 option tcp-check
9996 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9997 tcp-check expect string role:master
9998
9999 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10000 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10001
10002
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010003tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
10004 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010005 tcp health check
10006 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10007 no | no | yes | yes
10008
10009 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
10010 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010011 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010012 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
10013 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
10014 hexadecimal string.
10015 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
10016
10017 Examples :
10018 # redis check in binary
10019 option tcp-check
10020 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10021 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10022
10023
10024 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10025 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10026
10027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010028tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10029 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10031 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010032 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010033 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10034 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010035
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010036 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010037
10038 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10039 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010040 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10041 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10042 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10043 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10044 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10045 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010046
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010047 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10048 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10049 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10050 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010051
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010052 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010053 - accept :
10054 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10055 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10056 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010057
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010058 - reject :
10059 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10060 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10061 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10062 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10063 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10064 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10065 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10066 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10067 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10068 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10069 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010070 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010071
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010072 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10073 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10074 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10075 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10076 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10077 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10078 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10079 hosts.
10080
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010081 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10082 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10083 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10084 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10085 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10086 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10087 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10088 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10089
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010090 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10091 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10092 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10093 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10094 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10095 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10096 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10097 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10098 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010099 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10100 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010101
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010102 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010103 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010104 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10105 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10106 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010107 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010108 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10109 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10110 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10111 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10112 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10113 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10114 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10115 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010116
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010117 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010118 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010119 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010120 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010121 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10122 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10123 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010124
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010125 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10126 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10127 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10128 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010129
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010130 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10131 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10132 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10133 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10134 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010135 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10136 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10137 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10138 layer7 information is extracted.
10139
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010140 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10141 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10142 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10143 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10144 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010145
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010146 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10147 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10148 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10149 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10150
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010151 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10152 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10153 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10154 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10155
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010156 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
10157 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10158 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10159 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10160 continues.
10161
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010162 - set-src <expr> :
10163 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10164 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10165 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010166 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010167
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010168 Arguments:
10169 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10170 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010171
10172 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010173 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10174
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010175 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10176 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010177
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010178 - set-src-port <expr> :
10179 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10180 expression.
10181
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010182 Arguments:
10183 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10184 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010185
10186 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010187 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10188
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010189 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10190 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10191 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010192
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010193 - set-dst <expr> :
10194 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10195 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10196 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10197 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10198 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10199
10200 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10201 followed by some converters.
10202
10203 Example:
10204
10205 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10206 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10207
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010208 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10209 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10210
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010211 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10212 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10213 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10214 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10215
10216
10217 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10218 followed by some converters.
10219
10220 Example:
10221
10222 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10223
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010224 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10225 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10226 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10227
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010228 - "silent-drop" :
10229 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010230 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010231 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10232 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10233 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10234 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10235 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010236 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10237 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010238 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10239 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010240 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010241 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10242 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10243 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10244 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10245
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010246 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10247 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10248 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010249
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010250 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10251 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10252 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010253
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010254 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010255 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010256 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010257
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010258 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10259 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10260 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010261
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010262 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010263 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10264 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010265
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010266 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10267
10268 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10269
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010270 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10271
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010272 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010273
10274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010275tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10276 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010278 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010279 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010280 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10281 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010282
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010283 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010284
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010285 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010286 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10287 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10288 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10289 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010290
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010291 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10292 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10293 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10294 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010295 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10296 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10297 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10298 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10299 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10300 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010301 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010302 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010303
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010304 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10305 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10306 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10307 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010308
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010309 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010310 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010311 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010312 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10313 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010314 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010315 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010316 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010317 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +020010318 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010319 - set-dst <expr>
10320 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010321 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010322 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010323 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010324 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010325 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010326
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010327 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10328 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010329 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10330 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010331
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010332 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10333 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10334 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10335 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10336 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10337 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010339 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010340 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10341 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010342
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010343 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010344 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10345 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10346 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10347 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010348 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10349 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10350 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010351
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010352 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010353 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10354 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10355 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010356
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010357 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10358 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10359
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010360 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010361 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10362 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010363
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010364 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10365 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010366 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010367 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10368 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010369 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010370 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010371 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010372 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10373 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010374 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010375 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10376 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010377
10378 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10379 followed by some converters.
10380
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010381 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10382 <var-name>.
10383
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010384 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10385 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10386 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10387 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10388 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10389
10390 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10391 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10392 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10393 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10394 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10395 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10396 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10397 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10398 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10399 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10400 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10401
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010402 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10403 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10404 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10405 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10406 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10407
10408 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10409
10410 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10411
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010412 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10413 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10414 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10415 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10416 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10417 evaluated.
10418
10419 Example:
10420 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10421
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010422 Example:
10423
10424 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010425 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010426
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010427 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010428 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10429 # and reject everything else.
10430 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10431 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010432 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010433 tcp-request content reject
10434
10435 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010436 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10437 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10438 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010439 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010440
10441 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10442 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10443 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010444 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010445 tcp-request content reject
10446
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010447 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010448 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010449 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010450 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010451 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10452 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010453
10454 Example:
10455 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10456 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010457 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010458
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010459 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010460 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010461
10462 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010463 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010464 # protecting all our sites
10465 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010466 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10467 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010468 ...
10469 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10470
10471 backend http_dynamic
10472 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010473 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010474 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010475 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010476 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010477 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010478 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010479
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010480 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010481
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010482 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10483 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010484
10485
10486tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10487 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010489 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010490 Arguments :
10491 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10492 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10493 as explained at the top of this document.
10494
10495 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10496 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10497 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10498 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10499 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10500
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010501 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10502 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10503 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10504 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10505
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010506 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10507 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010508 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010509 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010510 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10511 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10512 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10513 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010514
10515 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10516 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10517 it pass through unaffected.
10518
10519 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10520 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10521 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010522 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010523 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10524 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010525 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10526 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10527 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010528
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010529 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010530 "timeout client".
10531
10532
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010533tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10534 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10536 no | no | yes | yes
10537 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010538 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10539 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010540
10541 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10542
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010543 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010544 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10545 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010546 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10547 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010548
10549 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10550
10551 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10552 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10553 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10554 inserted.
10555
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010556 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010557 - accept :
10558 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10559 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10560 the rules evaluation.
10561
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010562 - close :
10563 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10564 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10565 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10566 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10567 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10568 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010569 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010570 protocols.
10571
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010572 - reject :
10573 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10574 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010575 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010576
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010577 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10578 Sets a variable.
10579
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010580 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10581 Unsets a variable.
10582
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010583 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10584 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10585 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10586 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10587
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010588 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10589 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10590 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10591 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10592
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010593 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10594 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10595 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10596 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10597 continues.
10598
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010599 - "silent-drop" :
10600 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010601 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010602 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10603 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10604 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10605 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10606 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010607 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10608 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010609 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10610 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010611 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010612 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10613 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10614 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10615 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10616
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010617 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10618 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10619
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010620 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10621 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10622 for changing the default action to a reject.
10623
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010624 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10625 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10626 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10627 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010628 period.
10629
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010630 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10631 declared inline.
10632
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010633 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10634 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010635 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010636 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10637 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010638 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010639 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010640 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010641 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10642 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010643 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010644 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10645 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010646
10647 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10648 followed by some converters.
10649
10650 Example:
10651
10652 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10653
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010654 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10655 <var-name>.
10656
10657 Example:
10658
10659 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10660
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010661 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10662 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10663 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10664 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10665 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10666
10667 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10668
10669 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10670
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010671 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10672
10673 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10674
10675
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010676tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10677 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10679 no | yes | yes | no
10680 Arguments :
10681 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10682 below.
10683
10684 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10685
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010686 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010687 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10688 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10689 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10690 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10691 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10692 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10693 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010694 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010695 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10696 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10697 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10698 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10699 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10700 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10701 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10702 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10703 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10704 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10705 instead.
10706
10707 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10708 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10709 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10710 rules which may be inserted.
10711
10712 Several types of actions are supported :
10713 - accept : the request is accepted
10714 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10715 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10716 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010717 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010718 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10719 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010720 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010721 - silent-drop
10722
10723 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10724 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10725 sections for a complete description.
10726
10727 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10728 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10729 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10730
10731 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10732 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10733 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10734 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10735 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10736
10737 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10738 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10739
10740 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10741 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10742 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10743
10744 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10745 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10746 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10747
10748 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10749 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10750 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10751
10752 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10753 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10754 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10755
10756 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10757
10758 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10759
10760
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010761tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10762 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10764 no | no | yes | yes
10765 Arguments :
10766 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10767 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10768 as explained at the top of this document.
10769
10770 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10771
10772
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010773timeout check <timeout>
10774 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10775 established.
10776
10777 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10778 yes | no | yes | yes
10779 Arguments:
10780 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10781 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10782 as explained at the top of this document.
10783
10784 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10785 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010786 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010787 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010788 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10789 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10790 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010791
10792 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10793 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10794
10795 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10796 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010797 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010798
10799 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10800 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10801 forget about it.
10802
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010803 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10804 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010805
10806
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010807timeout client <timeout>
10808timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10809 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10811 yes | yes | yes | no
10812 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010813 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010814 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10815 as explained at the top of this document.
10816
10817 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10818 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10819 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010820 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10821 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10822 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10823 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010824 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10825 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10826 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010827 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010828 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010829 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10830 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010831 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10832 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010833
10834 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10835 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10836 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10837 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010838 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010839 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10840
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010841 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010842
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010843 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10844 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10845 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10846
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010847 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10848 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010849
10850
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010851timeout client-fin <timeout>
10852 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10854 yes | yes | yes | no
10855 Arguments :
10856 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10857 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10858 as explained at the top of this document.
10859
10860 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10861 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10862 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10863 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10864 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10865 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10866 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010867 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10868 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10869 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010870
10871 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10872 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10873 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10874
10875 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10876
10877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010878timeout connect <timeout>
10879timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10880 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10882 yes | no | yes | yes
10883 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010884 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010885 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10886 as explained at the top of this document.
10887
10888 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010889 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010890 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010891 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010892 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10893 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010894
10895 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10896 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10897 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10898 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010899 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010900 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10901
10902 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10903 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10904 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10905
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010906 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10907 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010908
10909
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010910timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10911 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10913 yes | yes | yes | yes
10914 Arguments :
10915 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10916 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10917 as explained at the top of this document.
10918
10919 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10920 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10921 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10922 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10923 once the request has started to present itself.
10924
10925 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10926 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10927 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10928 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10929 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10930
10931 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10932 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10933 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10934 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10935
10936 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10937 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010938 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010939 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10940 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010941 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010942
10943 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10944 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10945 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10946 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10947
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010948 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10949 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010950 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10951
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010952 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10953
10954
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010955timeout http-request <timeout>
10956 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010958 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010959 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010960 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010961 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10962 as explained at the top of this document.
10963
10964 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10965 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10966 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10967 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10968 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10969 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10970 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010971 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10972 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10973 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10974 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010975 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010976 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10977 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010978
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010979 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10980 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10981 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10982 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10983 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010984 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010985
10986 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10987 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010988 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010989 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10990 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10991
10992 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010993 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10994 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10995 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010996
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010997 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010998 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010999
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011000
11001timeout queue <timeout>
11002 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11004 yes | no | yes | yes
11005 Arguments :
11006 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11007 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11008 as explained at the top of this document.
11009
11010 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11011 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11012 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11013 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11014 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11015
11016 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11017 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11018 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11019 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11020
11021 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11022
11023
11024timeout server <timeout>
11025timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
11026 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11028 yes | no | yes | yes
11029 Arguments :
11030 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11031 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11032 as explained at the top of this document.
11033
11034 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11035 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11036 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11037 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11038 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11039 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11040 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11041
11042 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11043 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11044 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11045 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11046 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011047 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011048 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011049 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11050 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011051 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11052 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011053
11054 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11055 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11056 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11057 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011058 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011059 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11060
11061 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
11062 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
11063 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
11064
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011065 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011066
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011067
11068timeout server-fin <timeout>
11069 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11071 yes | no | yes | yes
11072 Arguments :
11073 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11074 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11075 as explained at the top of this document.
11076
11077 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11078 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11079 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11080 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11081 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11082 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11083 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11084 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11085 situations, it should not be needed.
11086
11087 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11088 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11089 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11090
11091 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11092
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011093
11094timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011095 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11097 yes | yes | yes | yes
11098 Arguments :
11099 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11100 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11101 as explained at the top of this document.
11102
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011103 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
11104 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
11105 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
11106 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011107
11108 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11109 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11110 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11111 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011112 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011113
11114 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11115
11116
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011117timeout tunnel <timeout>
11118 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11120 yes | no | yes | yes
11121 Arguments :
11122 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11123 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11124 as explained at the top of this document.
11125
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011126 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011127 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11128 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11129 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011130 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11131 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011132 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11133 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11134 specified.
11135
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011136 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11137 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11138 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11139 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11140 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11141 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11142 state.
11143
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011144 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11145 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11146 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11147 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011148 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011149
11150 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11151 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11152 forget about it.
11153
11154 Example :
11155 defaults http
11156 option http-server-close
11157 timeout connect 5s
11158 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011159 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011160 timeout server 30s
11161 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11162
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011163 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011164
11165
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011166transparent (deprecated)
11167 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011169 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011170 Arguments : none
11171
11172 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11173 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11174 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11175 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11176 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11177 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11178 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11179 appropriate server.
11180
11181 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11182
11183 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11184 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11185
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011186 See also: "option transparent"
11187
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011188unique-id-format <string>
11189 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11191 yes | yes | yes | no
11192 Arguments :
11193 <string> is a log-format string.
11194
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011195 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11196 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11197 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11198 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011199
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011200 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11201 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11202 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11203 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11204 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11205 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11206 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11207 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011208
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011209 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11210 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011211
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011212 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011213
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011214 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011215
11216 will generate:
11217
11218 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11219
11220 See also: "unique-id-header"
11221
11222unique-id-header <name>
11223 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11225 yes | yes | yes | no
11226 Arguments :
11227 <name> is the name of the header.
11228
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011229 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11230 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011231
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011232 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011233
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011234 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011235 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11236
11237 will generate:
11238
11239 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11240
11241 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011242
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011243use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011244 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11246 no | yes | yes | no
11247 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011248 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11249 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011250
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011251 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11252 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011253
11254 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11255 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11256 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011257 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011258 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011259 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11260 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011261
11262 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11263 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11264 assign the backend.
11265
11266 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11267 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11268 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11269 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11270 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11271 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11272
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011273 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011274 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011275 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11276 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11277 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11278
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011279 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11280 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11281 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11282 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11283 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11284 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11285 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11286 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11287 cannot be forced from the request.
11288
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011289 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011290 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11291 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11292
11293 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11294 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011295
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011296
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011297use-server <server> if <condition>
11298use-server <server> unless <condition>
11299 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11301 no | no | yes | yes
11302 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011303 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011304
11305 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11306
11307 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11308 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11309 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11310
11311 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11312 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11313 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11314 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11315 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11316 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11317 matches will assign the server.
11318
11319 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11320 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11321 with the next rules until one matches.
11322
11323 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11324 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11325 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11326 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11327
11328 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11329 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11330 stripped.
11331
11332 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11333 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11334 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11335 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11336
11337 Example :
11338 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11339 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11340 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11341 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11342 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11343 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011344 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011345 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11346 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11347
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011348 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011349
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011350
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100113515. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011352--------------------------
11353
11354The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11355depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11356settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11357written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11358described in this section.
11359
11360
113615.1. Bind options
11362-----------------
11363
11364The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11365as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11366no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11367parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11368while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11369provided immediately after the setting name.
11370
11371The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11372
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011373accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11374 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11375 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11376 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11377 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11378 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11379 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11380 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11381 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11382 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011383 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11384 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11385 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011386
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011387accept-proxy
11388 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011389 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11390 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011391 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11392 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11393 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11394 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011395 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011396 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11397 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011398 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11399 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011400
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011401allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011402 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011403 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011404 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011405 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11406 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011407
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011408alpn <protocols>
11409 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11410 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11411 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011412 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011413 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011414 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11415 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11416 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11417 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11418 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11419 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11420 preference, like below :
11421
11422 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011423
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011424backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011425 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011426 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11427
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011428curves <curves>
11429 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11430 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11431 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11432 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11433 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11434 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11435
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011436ecdhe <named curve>
11437 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011438 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11439 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011440
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011441ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011442 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11443 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11444 client's certificate.
11445
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011446ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11447 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11448 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11449 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11450 error is ignored.
11451
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011452ca-sign-file <cafile>
11453 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11454 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11455 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11456 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11457 'generate-certificates' for details.
11458
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011459ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011460 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11461 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11462 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11463 'generate-certificates' for details.
11464
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011465ciphers <ciphers>
11466 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11467 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011468 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011469 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011470 information and recommendations see e.g.
11471 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11472 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11473 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11474
11475ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11476 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11477 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11478 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11479 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011480 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11481 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011482
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011483crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011484 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11485 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11486 to verify client's certificate.
11487
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011488crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011489 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11490 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11491 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11492 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11493 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11494 file.
11495
11496 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11497 are loaded.
11498
11499 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011500 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011501 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11502 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11503 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11504 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011505 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11506 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011507 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011508
11509 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11510 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11511 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11512 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011513 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11514 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011515
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011516 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011517
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011518 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011519 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011520 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11521 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011522 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11523 clients).
11524
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011525 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11526 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11527 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11528 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11529 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11530 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11531 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11532 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11533 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11534 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11535 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11536 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11537 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11538
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011539 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11540 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11541 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11542 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11543 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11544
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011545 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11546 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11547 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11548 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011549
11550 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11551 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11552 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11553 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11554 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11555 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11556 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11557 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11558 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11559
11560 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11561
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011562 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011563 a cert bundle.
11564
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011565 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011566 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11567 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11568 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11569 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11570 provide multi-cert support.
11571
11572 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11573
11574 Filename | CN | SAN
11575 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11576 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011577 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011578 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11579 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11580
11581 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11582 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11583 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11584 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011585 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11586 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11587 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011588
11589 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11590 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11591
11592 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11593 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11594 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11595
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011596crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011597 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011598 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011599 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011600 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011601
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011602crt-list <file>
11603 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011604 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11605 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011606
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011607 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11608
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011609 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11610 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011611 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011612 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011613
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011614 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11615 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11616 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11617 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11618 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11619 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11620 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11621 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011622
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011623 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011624 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011625 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11626 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11627 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011628
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011629 crt-list file example:
11630 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011631 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011632 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011633 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011634
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011635defer-accept
11636 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11637 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11638 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011639 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011640 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11641 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11642 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11643 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11644 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11645 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11646 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11647
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011648expose-fd listeners
11649 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11650 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011651 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11652 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011653 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011654
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011655force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011656 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011657 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011658 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011659 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011660
11661force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011662 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011663 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011664 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011665
11666force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011667 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011668 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011669 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011670
11671force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011672 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011673 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011674 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011675
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011676force-tlsv13
11677 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11678 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011679 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011680
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011681generate-certificates
11682 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11683 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11684 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11685 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11686 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11687 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11688 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11689 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11690 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11691 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11692 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11693
11694 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11695 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011696 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011697 certificate is used many times.
11698
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011699gid <gid>
11700 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11701 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11702 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11703 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11704 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11705
11706group <group>
11707 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11708 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11709 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11710 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11711 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11712
11713id <id>
11714 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11715 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11716 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11717 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11718
11719interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011720 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11721 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11722 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11723 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11724 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11725 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011726 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11727 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11728 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11729 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11730 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11731 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011732
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011733level <level>
11734 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11735 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11736 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011737 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011738 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11739 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11740 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011741 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011742 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011743 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011744 all counters).
11745
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011746severity-output <format>
11747 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11748 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11749 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11750 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11751 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11752 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11753 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11754 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11755 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11756 rfc5424 convention.
11757
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011758maxconn <maxconn>
11759 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11760 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11761 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11762 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11763 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11764 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11765 eat all memory.
11766
11767mode <mode>
11768 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11769 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11770 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11771 UNIX sockets.
11772
11773mss <maxseg>
11774 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11775 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11776 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11777 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11778 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11779 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11780 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11781 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11782 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11783 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11784 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11785
11786name <name>
11787 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11788 page.
11789
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011790namespace <name>
11791 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11792 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11793 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11794 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11795
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011796nice <nice>
11797 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11798 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11799 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11800 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11801 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11802 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11803 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11804 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11805 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11806 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11807 one for an RDP socket.
11808
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011809no-ca-names
11810 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11811 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11812
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011813no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011814 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011815 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011816 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011817 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011818 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11819 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011820
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011821no-tls-tickets
11822 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11823 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11824 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011825 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11826 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010011827 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
11828 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
11829 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011830
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011831no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011832 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011833 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011834 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011835 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011836 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11837 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011838
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011839no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011841 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011842 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011843 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011844 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11845 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011846
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011847no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011849 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011850 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011851 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011852 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11853 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011854
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011855no-tlsv13
11856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11857 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11858 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11859 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011860 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11861 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011862
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011863npn <protocols>
11864 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11865 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11866 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011867 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011868 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011869 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11870 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11871 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11872 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11873 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011874
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011875prefer-client-ciphers
11876 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11877 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11878 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011879 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11880 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11881 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011882
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011883process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011884 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011885 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011886 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011887 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11888 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11889 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11890 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011891 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011892 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11893 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11894 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11895 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11896 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011897
11898 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11899
11900 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11901 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11902 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11903 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11904 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11905 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11906 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11907 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011908
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011909proto <name>
11910 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11911 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11912 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11913 in haproxy -vv.
11914 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11915 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011916 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011917 h2" on the bind line.
11918
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011919ssl
11920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011921 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011922 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11923 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011924 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11925 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011926
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011927ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11928 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11929 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11930 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11931
11932ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11933 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11934 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11935 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11936
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011937strict-sni
11938 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11939 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11940 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11941 See the "crt" option for more information.
11942
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011943tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011944 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011945 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11946 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011947 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011948 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11949 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11950 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11951 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11952 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11953 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11954 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11955
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011956tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011957 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011958 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11959 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11960 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11961 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11962 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11963 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11964 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011965 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11966 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11967 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011968
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011969tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11970 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011971 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11972 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11973 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11974 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11975 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11976 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11977 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11978 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11979 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11980 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011981 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11982 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11983
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011984transparent
11985 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11986 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11987 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11988 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11989 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11990 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11991 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11992 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11993 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11994 so check for support with your vendor.
11995
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011996v4v6
11997 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11998 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11999 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12000 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012001 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012002
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012003v6only
12004 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12005 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12006 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012007 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12008 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012009
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012010uid <uid>
12011 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12012 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12013 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12014 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12015 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12016
12017user <user>
12018 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12019 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12020 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12021 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12022 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12023
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012024verify [none|optional|required]
12025 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12026 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12027 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12028 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12029 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012030 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12031 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12032 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12033 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012034
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200120355.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012036------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012038The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12039which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12040arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12041settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12042after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12043Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12044address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012046 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012047 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012048
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012049Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12050keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12051
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012052The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012053
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012054addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012055 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012056 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12057 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12058 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12059 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12060 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012061
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012062agent-check
12063 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012064 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012065 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12066 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12067 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012068
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012069 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012070 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012071 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12072 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12073 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012074
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012075 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12076 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12077 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12078 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12079 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012080
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012081 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012082 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012083
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012084 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12085 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12086 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012087
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012088 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12089 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12090 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012091
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012092 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12093 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12094 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12095 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12096 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012097 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012098 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012099
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012100 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12101 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012102
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012103 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12104 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12105 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12106 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12107 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12108 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12109 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12110 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12111 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012112
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012113 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12114 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012115 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12116 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12117 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012118 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012119
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012120 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012121 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012122
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012123agent-send <string>
12124 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12125 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12126 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12127 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12128 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12129
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012130agent-inter <delay>
12131 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12132 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12133
12134 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12135 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12136 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12137 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12138 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12139 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12140 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12141 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12142 of backends use the same servers.
12143
12144 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12145
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012146agent-addr <addr>
12147 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12148
12149 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12150 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12151 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12152 hostname, it will be resolved.
12153
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012154agent-port <port>
12155 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12156
12157 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12158
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012159allow-0rtt
12160 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012161 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12162 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012163
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012164alpn <protocols>
12165 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12166 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12167 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012168 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012169 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12170 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12171 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12172 now obsolete NPN extension.
12173 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12174 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12175
12176 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012178backup
12179 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12180 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12181 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12182 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012183 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12184 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012185
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012186ca-file <cafile>
12187 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12188 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12189 server's certificate.
12190
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012191check
12192 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012193 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12194 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12195 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12196 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12197 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12198 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12199 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012200 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12201 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012202 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12203 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012204
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012205check-send-proxy
12206 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12207 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12208 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12209 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12210 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12211 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12212 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12213
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012214check-alpn <protocols>
12215 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12216 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12217 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12218
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012219check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012220 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012221 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12222 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012223
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012224check-ssl
12225 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12226 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12227 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12228 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012229 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012230 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12231 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012232 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012233 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12234 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012235
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012236check-via-socks4
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012237 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012238 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12239 for normal traffic.
12240
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012241ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012242 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12243 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12244 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012245 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12246 information and recommendations see e.g.
12247 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12248 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12249 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012250
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012251ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12253 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12254 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12255 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012256 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12257 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12258 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012260cookie <value>
12261 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12262 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12263 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12264 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12265 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12266 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12267 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12268
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012269crl-file <crlfile>
12270 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12271 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12272 to verify server's certificate.
12273
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012274crt <cert>
12275 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12276 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12277 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12278 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12279 certificate request.
12280
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012281disabled
12282 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12283 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12284 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12285 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12286 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012287 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012288
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012289enabled
12290 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12291 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12292 default value.
12293 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12294 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012295
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012296error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012297 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12298 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12299 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012301 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012302
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012303fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012304 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12305 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12306 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12307
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012308force-sslv3
12309 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12310 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012311 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012312 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012313
12314force-tlsv10
12315 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012316 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012317 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012318
12319force-tlsv11
12320 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012321 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012322 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012323
12324force-tlsv12
12325 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012326 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012327 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012328
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012329force-tlsv13
12330 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12331 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012332 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012333
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012334id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012335 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12336 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12337 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012338
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012339init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12340 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12341 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012342 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012343 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12344 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12345 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12346 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12347 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12348 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12349 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12350 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12351 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012352 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012353 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12354 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12355 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12356 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12357 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12358 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012359 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012360
12361 Example:
12362 defaults
12363 # never fail on address resolution
12364 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12365
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012366inter <delay>
12367fastinter <delay>
12368downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012369 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12370 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12371 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12372 between checks depending on the server state :
12373
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012374 Server state | Interval used
12375 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12376 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12377 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12378 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12379 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12380 or yet unchecked. |
12381 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12382 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12383 | "inter" otherwise.
12384 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012385
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012386 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12387 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12388 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12389 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012390 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12391 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12392 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12393 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12394 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012395
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012396maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012397 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12398 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012399 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12400 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012401 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12402 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12403 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12404 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12405
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012406 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12407 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12408 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12409 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12410 than 50 concurrent requests.
12411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012412maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012413 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12414 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12415 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12416 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12417 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12418 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12419 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12420
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012421max-reuse <count>
12422 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12423 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12424 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12425 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12426 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12427 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12428 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12429 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12430
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012431minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012432 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12433 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12434 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12435 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12436 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12437 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012438 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012439 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012440
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012441namespace <name>
12442 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12443 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12444 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12445 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12446
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012447no-agent-check
12448 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12449 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12450 default value.
12451 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12452 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12453
12454no-backup
12455 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12456 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12457 default value.
12458 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12459 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12460
12461no-check
12462 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12463 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12464 default value.
12465 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12466 "default-server" "check" setting.
12467
12468no-check-ssl
12469 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12470 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12471 default value.
12472 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12473 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12474
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012475no-send-proxy
12476 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12477 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12478 default value.
12479 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12480 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12481
12482no-send-proxy-v2
12483 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12484 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12485 default value.
12486 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12487 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12488
12489no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12490 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12491 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12492 default value.
12493 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12494 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12495
12496no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12497 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12498 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12499 default value.
12500 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12501 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12502
12503no-ssl
12504 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12505 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12506 default value.
12507 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12508 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12509
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012510no-ssl-reuse
12511 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12512 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12513 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12514 and for paranoid users.
12515
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012516no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012517 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12518 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012519 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012520
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012521 Supported in default-server: No
12522
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012523no-tls-tickets
12524 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12525 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12526 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012527 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12528 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012529 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12530 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12531 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012532 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012533
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012534no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012535 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012536 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12537 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012538 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12539 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012540 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012541
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012542 Supported in default-server: No
12543
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012544no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012545 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012546 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12547 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012548 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12549 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012550 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012551
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012552 Supported in default-server: No
12553
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012554no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012555 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012556 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12557 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012558 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12559 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012560 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012561
12562 Supported in default-server: No
12563
12564no-tlsv13
12565 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12566 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12567 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12568 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12569 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012570 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012571
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012572 Supported in default-server: No
12573
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012574no-verifyhost
12575 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12576 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12577 default value.
12578 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12579 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012580
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012581no-tfo
12582 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12583 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12584 default value.
12585 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12586 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12587
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012588non-stick
12589 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12590 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12591 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12592
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012593npn <protocols>
12594 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12595 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12596 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012597 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012598 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12599 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12600 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12601
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012602observe <mode>
12603 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12604 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12605 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12606 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12607 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12608 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012609 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012610
12611 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12612
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012613on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012614 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12615 Currently, four modes are available:
12616 - fastinter: force fastinter
12617 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12618 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12619 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12620 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12621
12622 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12623
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012624on-marked-down <action>
12625 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12626 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012627 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12628 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12629 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12630 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12631 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12632 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12633 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12634 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012635
12636 Actions are disabled by default
12637
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012638on-marked-up <action>
12639 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12640 Currently one action is available:
12641 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12642 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12643 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12644 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012645 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12646 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012647 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12648 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12649
12650 Actions are disabled by default
12651
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012652pool-max-conn <max>
12653 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12654 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12655 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12656 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12657 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12658 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12659
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012660pool-purge-delay <delay>
12661 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012662 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012663 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012664
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012665port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012666 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12667 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12668 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12669 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12670 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12671 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12672
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012673proto <name>
12674
12675 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12676 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12677 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12678 reported in haproxy -vv.
12679 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12680 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12681
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012682redir <prefix>
12683 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12684 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12685 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12686 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12687 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12688 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12689 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12690 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012691 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012692 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012693 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12694 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12695 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12696 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12697
12698 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12699
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012700rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012701 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12702 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12703 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12704
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012705resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12706 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12707 server.
12708
12709 Available options:
12710
12711 * allow-dup-ip
12712 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12713 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12714 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12715 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12716 For such case, simply enable this option.
12717 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12718
12719 * prevent-dup-ip
12720 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12721 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12722 same fqdn.
12723 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12724
12725 Example:
12726 backend b_myapp
12727 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12728 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12729 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12730
12731 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12732 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12733 it
12734 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12735 different address
12736
12737 Default value: not set
12738
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012739resolve-prefer <family>
12740 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12741 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12742 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12743 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12744
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012745 Default value: ipv6
12746
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012747 Example:
12748
12749 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012750
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012751resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012752 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012753 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012754 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012755 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12756 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012757 configured network, another address is selected.
12758
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012759 Example:
12760
12761 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012762
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012763resolvers <id>
12764 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12765 hostname.
12766
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012767 Example:
12768
12769 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012770
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012771 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012772
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012773send-proxy
12774 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12775 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12776 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12777 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012778 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12779 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12780 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12781 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12782 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12783 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12784 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12785 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12786 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12787 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012788 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12789 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012790
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012791send-proxy-v2
12792 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12793 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12794 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12795 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012796 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12797 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12798 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12799 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012800
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012801proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12802 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12803 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012804 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12805 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012806 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12807 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012808 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012809
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012810send-proxy-v2-ssl
12811 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12812 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12813 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12814 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12815 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12816 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12817 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012818 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12819 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012820
12821send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12822 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12823 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12824 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12825 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12826 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12827 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12828 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12829 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012830 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12831 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012832
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012833slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012834 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12835 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12836 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12837 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12838 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12839 parameters :
12840
12841 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12842 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12843
12844 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12845 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12846 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12847 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12848
12849 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12850 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12851 seen as failed.
12852
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012853sni <expression>
12854 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12855 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12856 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12857 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012858 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12859 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012860 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012861 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12862 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012863
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012864source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012865source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012866source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012867 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12868 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12869 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12870 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12871
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012872 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12873 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12874 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12875 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12876 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12877 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12878 server.
12879
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012880 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12881 specifying the source address without port(s).
12882
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012883ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012884 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12885 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12886 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12887 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12888 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12889 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012890 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12891 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012892
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012893ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12894 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12895 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12896 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12897
12898ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12899 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12900 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12901 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12902
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012903ssl-reuse
12904 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12905 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12906 default value.
12907 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12908 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12909
12910stick
12911 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12912 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12913 default value.
12914 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12915 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012916
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012917socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012918 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012919 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12920 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12921
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012922tcp-ut <delay>
12923 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12924 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12925 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012926 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012927 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12928 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12929 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12930 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12931 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12932 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12933 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12934 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12935 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12936
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012937tfo
12938 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12939 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12940 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12941 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12942 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012943 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012945track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012946 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12947 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12948 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12949 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012950 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12951
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012952tls-tickets
12953 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12954 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12955 default value.
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012956 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12957 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12958 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012959 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke04037d32020-02-13 14:16:16 +010012960 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012961
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012962verify [none|required]
12963 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012964 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012965 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12966 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012967 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012968 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12969 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12970 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12971 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12972 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12973 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12974 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12975 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012976
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012977verifyhost <hostname>
12978 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012979 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12980 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12981 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12982 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12983 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12984 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12985 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12986 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012987
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012988weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012989 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12990 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12991 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012992 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12993 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12994 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12995 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12996 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12997 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012998
12999
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130005.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13001-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013002
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013003HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13004using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13005configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013006This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13007can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13008workload.
13009This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13010resolution at run time.
13011Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13012carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13013
13014
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130155.3.1. Global overview
13016----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013017
13018As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13019different steps of the process life:
13020
13021 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13022 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13023 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13024
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013025 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13026 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013027
13028A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13029 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13030 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13031 resolution to know this new IP.
13032
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013033When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013034HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013035SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13036from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13037will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13038will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013039
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013040A few things important to notice:
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013041 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013042 first valid response.
13043
13044 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13045 servers return an error.
13046
13047
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130485.3.2. The resolvers section
13049----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013050
13051This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013052HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13053contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013054
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013055When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13056uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13057is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13058answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13059
13060When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013061used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013062
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013063 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13064 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13065 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013066
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013067 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13068 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013069
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013070 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13071 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13072 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013073
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013074For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13075following scenarios are possible:
13076
13077 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13078 ignored
13079
13080 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13081 applied
13082
13083 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13084 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13085
13086 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13087 retries the query with a new type
13088
13089 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13090 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013091
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013092As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13093a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013094<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013095
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013096
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013097resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013098 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013099
13100A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13101
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013102accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013103 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013104 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013105 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13106 by RFC 6891)
13107
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013108 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13109
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013110nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13111 DNS server description:
13112 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13113 <ip> : IP address of the server
13114 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13115
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013116parse-resolv-conf
13117 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13118 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13119 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13120
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013121hold <status> <period>
13122 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13123 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013124 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013125 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013126 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13127 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13128 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13129
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013130 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013131
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013132resolve_retries <nb>
13133 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13134 giving up.
13135 Default value: 3
13136
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013137 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13138 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13139 type.
13140
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013141timeout <event> <time>
13142 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13143 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13144 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013145 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13146 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013147 Default value: 1s
13148 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013149 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013150 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013151 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13152 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13153
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013154 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013155
13156 resolvers mydns
13157 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13158 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013159 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013160 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013161 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013162 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013163 hold other 30s
13164 hold refused 30s
13165 hold nx 30s
13166 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013167 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013168 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013169
13170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131716. HTTP header manipulation
13172---------------------------
13173
13174In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
13175response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
13176request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
13177which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013178against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013179
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013180If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
13181to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
13182but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
13183HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
13184stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
13185because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
13186a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
13187still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020013188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013189This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
13190in section 4.2 :
13191
13192 - reqadd <string>
13193 - reqallow <search>
13194 - reqiallow <search>
13195 - reqdel <search>
13196 - reqidel <search>
13197 - reqdeny <search>
13198 - reqideny <search>
13199 - reqpass <search>
13200 - reqipass <search>
13201 - reqrep <search> <replace>
13202 - reqirep <search> <replace>
13203 - reqtarpit <search>
13204 - reqitarpit <search>
13205 - rspadd <string>
13206 - rspdel <search>
13207 - rspidel <search>
13208 - rspdeny <search>
13209 - rspideny <search>
13210 - rsprep <search> <replace>
13211 - rspirep <search> <replace>
13212
13213With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
13214is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
13215parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
13216prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
13217Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
13218
13219 \t for a tab
13220 \r for a carriage return (CR)
13221 \n for a new line (LF)
13222 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
13223 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
13224 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
13225 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
13226 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
13227
13228The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
13229portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
13230above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
13231regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
132329 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
13233is very common to users of the "sed" program.
13234
13235The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
13236after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
13237
13238Notes related to these keywords :
13239---------------------------------
13240 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
13241 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
13242 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
13243
13244 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
13245 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
13246 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
13247
13248 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
13249 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
13250 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
13251 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
13252 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
13253
13254 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
13255 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
13256 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
13257 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
13258 useless headers before adding new ones.
13259
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013260 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013261 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
13262
13263 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
13264 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
13265 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
13266
13267 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
13268 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013269 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013270
13271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132727. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13273----------------------------------
13274
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013275HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013276client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13277The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13278these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13279but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13280data called patterns.
13281
13282
132837.1. ACL basics
13284---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013285
13286The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13287content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13288from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13289simple :
13290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013291 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013292 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013293 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13294 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013296The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13297adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013298
13299In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013301 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013302
13303This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13304Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13305and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013306an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13307conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13308as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13309are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013310
13311ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13312'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13313which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13314
13315There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13316performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013318The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13319specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13320this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013321methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13322ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013323
13324Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13325 - boolean
13326 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13327 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13328 - string
13329 - data block
13330
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013331Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13332converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13333would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13334The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13335which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13336
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013337Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13338keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13339fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13340which are summarized in the table below :
13341
13342 +---------------------+-----------------+
13343 | Sample or converter | Default |
13344 | output type | matching method |
13345 +---------------------+-----------------+
13346 | boolean | bool |
13347 +---------------------+-----------------+
13348 | integer | int |
13349 +---------------------+-----------------+
13350 | ip | ip |
13351 +---------------------+-----------------+
13352 | string | str |
13353 +---------------------+-----------------+
13354 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13355 +---------------------+-----------------+
13356
13357Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13358matching method, see below.
13359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013360The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13361 - boolean
13362 - integer or integer range
13363 - IP address / network
13364 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13365 - regular expression
13366 - hex block
13367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013368The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13369
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013370 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13371 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013372 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013373 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013374 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013375 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013376 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013378The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13379read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13380if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13381lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13382will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13383beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13384a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13385lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13386exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13387
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013388The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13389parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13390ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13391a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13392check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13393
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013394The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13395socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13396file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013398Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13399loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13400
13401 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13402
13403In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13404the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13405case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13406as well.
13407
13408The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13409sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13410do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13411methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13412is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013413obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013414followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13415default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13416that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13417string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13418
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013419The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13420By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13421string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13422resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13423server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013424waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013425flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13426function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013428There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13429sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13430be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013431
13432 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13433 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013434 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13435 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13436 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13437 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013438
13439 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13440 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013441 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013442
13443 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013444 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013445
13446 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013447 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013448
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013449 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013450 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13451
13452 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13453 binary or string samples.
13454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013455 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13456 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013458 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13459 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13460 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013462 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13463 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013465 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13466 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013468 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13469 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013471 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13472 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013473 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013475 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13476 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13477 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013478
13479For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13480request, it is possible to do :
13481
13482 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13483
13484In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13485buffer, one would use the following acl :
13486
13487 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13488
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013489On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13490possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13491
13492 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013494All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13495criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13496method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13497to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13498criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13499the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013501If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013502the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13503For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013505 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13506 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13507 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13508 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013509
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013510
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013511The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13512types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13513combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13514brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13515default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013517 +-------------------------------------------------+
13518 | Input sample type |
13519 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013520 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013521 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13522 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13523 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013524 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013525 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013526 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013527 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013528 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013529 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013530 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013531 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013532 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013533 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013534 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013535 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013536 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013537 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013538 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013539 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013540 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013541 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013542 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013543 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013544 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013545 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13546 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13547 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013548
13549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135507.1.1. Matching booleans
13551------------------------
13552
13553In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13554Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13555When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13556that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13557
13558Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13559return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13560"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13561
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135637.1.2. Matching integers
13564------------------------
13565
13566Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13567enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13568to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13569
13570Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13571matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13572lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013573
13574For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13575unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13576representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13577
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013578As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13579two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13580instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13581ranges and operators.
13582
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013583For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013584operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13585Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13586of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013587
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013588Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013589
13590 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13591 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13592 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13593 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13594 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13595
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013596For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013597
13598 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13599
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013600This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13601
13602 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13603
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136057.1.3. Matching strings
13606-----------------------
13607
13608String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13609different forms :
13610
13611 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013612 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013613
13614 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013615 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013616
13617 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13618 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13619
13620 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13621 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13622
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013623 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013624 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13625 matches.
13626
13627 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13628 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13629 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013630
13631String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13632exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13633characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13634string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13635to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013636before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013637
Mathias Weiersmuellerb2fe2232019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013638Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13639(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13640Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13641
13642Example:
13643 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13644 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136477.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13648---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013649
13650Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13651they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13652possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13653passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13654the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013655the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13656match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013657
13658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136597.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13660-------------------------------------
13661
13662It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13663not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13664a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13665to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13666digits may be used upper or lower case.
13667
13668Example :
13669 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13670 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13671
13672
136737.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13674---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013675
13676IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13677netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13678within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013679host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013680difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13681at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13682does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13683parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013684
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013685The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13686abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13687
13688 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13689 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13690 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13691 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13692 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13693 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13694 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13695 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13696
13697Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13698192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13699
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013700IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13701Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13702trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13703IPv6 patterns.
13704
13705HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13706following situations :
13707 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13708 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13709 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13710 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13711 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13712 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13713 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13714 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13715 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13716 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013718
137197.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13720----------------------------------
13721
13722Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13723combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13724
13725 - AND (implicit)
13726 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13727 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013729A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013731 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013733Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13734indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013736For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13737"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13738requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13739is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13740
13741 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013742 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13743 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13744 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013745
13746To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13747and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13748
13749 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13750 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13751 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13752 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13753
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013754 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013755 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13756 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13757 use_backend www if host_www
13758
13759It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13760expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13761be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13762the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13763
13764 The following rule :
13765
13766 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013767 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013768
13769 Can also be written that way :
13770
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013771 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013772
13773It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13774to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13775simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13776sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13777good use is the following :
13778
13779 With named ACLs :
13780
13781 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13782 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13783 monitor fail if site_dead
13784
13785 With anonymous ACLs :
13786
13787 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13788
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013789See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13790keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013791
13792
137937.3. Fetching samples
13794---------------------
13795
13796Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13797against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13798sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13799ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13800of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13801available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13802
13803This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13804Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13805compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13806deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13807
13808The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13809matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13810method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13811indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13812
13813As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13814when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13815mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13816the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13817ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13818
13819Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13820multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13821when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013822incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13823are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013824is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13825all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13826
13827Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13828 - name
13829 - name(arg1)
13830 - name(arg1,arg2)
13831
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013832
138337.3.1. Converters
13834-----------------
13835
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013836Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13837of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13838is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13839was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013840has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013841unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13842
13843These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13844sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13845the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013846support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013847
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013848A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13849support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13850supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13851(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13852bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013854The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013855
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001385651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13857 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13858 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13859 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13860 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13861 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13862
13863 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013864 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13865 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013866 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13867 frontend http-in
13868 bind *:8081
13869 default_backend servers
13870 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13871 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13872
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013873add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013874 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013875 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013876 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13877 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013878 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013879 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13880 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13881 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13882 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013883 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013884 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013885
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013886aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13887 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13888 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13889 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13890 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13891 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13892 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13893
13894 Example:
13895 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13896 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13897
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013898and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013899 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013900 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013901 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13902 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013903 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013904 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13905 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13906 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13907 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013908 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013909 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013910
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013911b64dec
13912 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13913 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13914
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013915base64
13916 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013917 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013918 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13919
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013920bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013921 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013922 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013923 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013924 presence of a flag).
13925
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013926bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13927 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13928 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013929 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013930
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013931concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13932 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13933 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13934 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13935 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13936 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13937 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13938 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13939 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13940 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13941 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013942 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013943 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013944 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013945
13946 Example:
13947 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13948 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13949 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13950 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13951
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013952cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013953 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13954 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013955
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013956crc32([<avalanche>])
13957 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13958 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13959 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13960 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13961 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13962 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13963 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13964 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13965 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13966 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013967 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13968
13969crc32c([<avalanche>])
13970 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13971 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13972 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13973 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13974 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13975 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13976 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13977 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013978
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013979da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013980 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13981 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13982 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13983 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013984 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013985 configuration language.
13986
13987 Example:
13988 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013989 bind *:8881
13990 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013991 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013992
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013993debug
13994 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13995 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13996 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13997
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013998div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013999 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14000 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014001 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014002 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14003 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014004 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014005 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14006 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14007 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14008 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014009 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014010 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014011
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014012djb2([<avalanche>])
14013 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14014 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14015 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14016 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14017 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14018 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14019 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014020 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14021 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014022
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014023even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014024 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014025 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14026
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014027field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14028 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14029 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14030 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14031 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14032 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14033 fields.
14034
14035 Example :
14036 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14037 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14038 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14039 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14040 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014041
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014042hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014043 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014044 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014045 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014046 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014047
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014048hex2i
14049 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014050 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014051
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014052http_date([<offset>])
14053 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14054 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
14055 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
14056 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
14057 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
14058 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014059
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014060in_table(<table>)
14061 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14062 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14063 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014064 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014065 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14066
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014067ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14068 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014069 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014070 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14071 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14072 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14073 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14074 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014075
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014076json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014077 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014078 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014079 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014080 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14081 of errors:
14082 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14083 bytes, ...)
14084 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14085 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14086
14087 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14088 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14089 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14090 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14091 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14092 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014093 - "ascii" : never fails;
14094 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14095 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014096 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014097 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014098 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14099 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14100
14101 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014102 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014103
14104 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014105 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014106 capture request header user-agent len 150
14107 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014108
14109 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14110 GET / HTTP/1.0
14111 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14112
14113 Output log:
14114 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14115
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014116language(<value>[,<default>])
14117 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14118 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14119 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14120 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14121 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14122 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14123 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14124 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14125 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014126 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014127 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14128 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014129
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014130 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014131
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014132 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14133 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014134
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014135 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14136 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14137 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14138 use_backend spanish if es
14139 use_backend french if fr
14140 use_backend english if en
14141 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014142
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014143length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014144 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14145 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14146 type. The result is of type integer.
14147
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014148lower
14149 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14150 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14151 type. The result is of type string.
14152
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014153ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14154 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14155 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14156 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14157 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14158 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14159 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14160
14161 Example :
14162
14163 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014164 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014165 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14166
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014167map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14168map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14169map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14170 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14171 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14172 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14173 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14174 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14175 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14176 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14177 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014178
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014179 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14180 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14181 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014182
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014183 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014184 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014185
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014186 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14187 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14188 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14189 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014190 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14191 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014192 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14193 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14194 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14195 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14196 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14197 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14198 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14199 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014200 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14201 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14202 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014203 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14204 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14205 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14206 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14207 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014208
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014209 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14210 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14211 the corresponding match text.
14212
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014213 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14214 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14215 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14216 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14217 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014218
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014219 Example :
14220
14221 # this is a comment and is ignored
14222 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14223 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14224 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14225 | | | `---------- value
14226 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14227 | `---------------------------- key
14228 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14229
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014230mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014231 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14232 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014233 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014234 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014235 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014236 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14237 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14238 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14239 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014240 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014241 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014242
14243mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014244 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014245 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14246 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014247 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014248 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014249 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014250 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14251 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14252 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14253 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014254 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014255 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014256
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014257nbsrv
14258 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14259 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14260 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14261 map lookup.
14262
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014263neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014264 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14265 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14266 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14267 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014268
14269not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014270 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014271 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014272 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014273 absence of a flag).
14274
14275odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014276 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014277 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14278
14279or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014280 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014281 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014282 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14283 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014284 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014285 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14286 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14287 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14288 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014289 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014290 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014291
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014292protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14293 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14294 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14295 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14296 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14297 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14298 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14299 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14300 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14301 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14302 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14303 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14304
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014305regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014306 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14307 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14308 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14309 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14310 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14311 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14312 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14313 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14314 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14315 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014316 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14317 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14318 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14319 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014320
14321 Example :
14322
14323 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14324 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14325 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14326 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14327
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014328capture-req(<id>)
14329 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14330 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14331
14332 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014333 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14334 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014335
14336capture-res(<id>)
14337 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14338 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14339
14340 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014341 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14342 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014343
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014344sdbm([<avalanche>])
14345 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14346 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14347 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14348 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14349 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14350 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14351 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014352 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14353 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014354
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014355set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014356 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14357 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14358 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014359 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014360 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14361 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014362 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014363 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14364 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014365 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014366 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014367
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014368sha1
14369 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
14370 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14371
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014372strcmp(<var>)
14373 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14374 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14375 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14376 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14377 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14378 shorter).
14379
14380 Example :
14381
14382 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14383 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14384 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14385
14386
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014387sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014388 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14389 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014390 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014391 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14392 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014393 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014394 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14395 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014396 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014397 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14398 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014399 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014400 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014401
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014402table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14403 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14404 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14405 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14406 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14407 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14408 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14409
14410
14411table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14412 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14413 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14414 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14415 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14416 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14417 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14418
14419table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14420 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14421 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014422 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014423 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14424 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14425
14426table_conn_cur(<table>)
14427 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14428 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14429 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14430 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14431 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14432
14433table_conn_rate(<table>)
14434 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14435 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14436 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14437 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14438 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14439
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014440table_gpt0(<table>)
14441 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14442 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14443 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14444 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14445 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14446
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014447table_gpc0(<table>)
14448 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14449 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14450 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14451 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14452 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14453
14454table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14455 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14456 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14457 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14458 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14459 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14460 sample fetch keyword.
14461
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014462table_gpc1(<table>)
14463 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14464 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14465 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14466 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14467 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14468
14469table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14470 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14471 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14472 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14473 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14474 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14475 sample fetch keyword.
14476
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014477table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14478 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14479 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014480 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014481 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14482 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14483
14484table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14485 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14486 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14487 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14488 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14489 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14490 keyword.
14491
14492table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14493 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14494 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014495 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014496 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14497 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14498
14499table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14500 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14501 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14502 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14503 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14504 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14505 keyword.
14506
14507table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14508 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14509 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014510 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014511 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14512 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14513 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14514 keyword.
14515
14516table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14517 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14518 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014519 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014520 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14521 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14522 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14523 keyword.
14524
14525table_server_id(<table>)
14526 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14527 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14528 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14529 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14530 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14531 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14532
14533table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14534 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14535 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014536 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014537 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14538 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14539 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14540 keyword.
14541
14542table_sess_rate(<table>)
14543 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14544 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14545 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14546 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14547 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14548 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14549 keyword.
14550
14551table_trackers(<table>)
14552 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14553 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14554 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14555 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14556 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14557 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14558 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14559 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14560 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14561 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14562
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014563upper
14564 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14565 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14566 type. The result is of type string.
14567
Willy Tarreau7e913cb2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020014568url_dec([<in_form>])
14569 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
14570 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
14571 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
14572 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
14573 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
14574 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014575
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014576ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014577 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014578 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14579 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14580 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014581 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14582 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14583 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14584 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014585 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014586 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14587 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014588
14589 Example:
14590 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14591 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14592
14593 message Point {
14594 int32 latitude = 1;
14595 int32 longitude = 2;
14596 }
14597
14598 message PPoint {
14599 Point point = 59;
14600 }
14601
14602 message Rectangle {
14603 // One corner of the rectangle.
14604 PPoint lo = 48;
14605 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14606 PPoint hi = 49;
14607 }
14608
14609 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14610 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14611 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14612
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014613 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14614 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014615 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014616 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14617
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014618 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014619
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014620 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014621
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014622 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014623 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14624 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14625
14626 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14627 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14628 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14629
14630 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14631 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14632 interpret the previous binary sample.
14633
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014634
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014635unset-var(<var name>)
14636 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14637 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14638 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14639 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14640 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14641 response),
14642 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14643 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14644 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14645 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14646
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014647utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14648 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14649 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14650 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14651 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14652 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14653 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14654
14655 Example :
14656
14657 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014658 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014659 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14660
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014661word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14662 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14663 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14664 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnind1fa5fa2020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014665 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014666 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14667 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14668
14669 Example :
14670 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14671 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14672 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14673 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14674 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnind1fa5fa2020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014675 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014676
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014677wt6([<avalanche>])
14678 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14679 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14680 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14681 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14682 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14683 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14684 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014685 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14686 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014687
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014688xor(<value>)
14689 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014690 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014691 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014692 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014693 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014694 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14695 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014696 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014697 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14698 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014699 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014700 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014701
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014702xxh32([<seed>])
14703 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14704 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14705 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14706 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14707 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14708 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14709 as cryptographically secure.
14710
14711xxh64([<seed>])
14712 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14713 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14714 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14715 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14716 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14717 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14718 as cryptographically secure.
14719
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014720
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147217.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014722--------------------------------------------
14723
14724A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14725not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14726"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14727The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14728
14729always_false : boolean
14730 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14731 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14732
14733always_true : boolean
14734 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14735 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14736
14737avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014738 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014739 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14740 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14741 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14742 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14743 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14744 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14745 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14746 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14747 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14748 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14749 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14750 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14751 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014753be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014754 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14755 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14756 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14757 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014758 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14759
14760be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14761 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14762 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14763 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14764 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14765 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014766 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14767 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014768
14769 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14770 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14771 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014773be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14774 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14775 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14776 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014777 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014778 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14779 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014780
14781 Example :
14782 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14783 backend dynamic
14784 mode http
14785 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14786 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014787
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014788bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014789 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14790 of the string.
14791
14792bool(<bool>) : bool
14793 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14794 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014796connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14797 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014798 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014799 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14800 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014801
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014802 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014803 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014804 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14805
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014806 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14807 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014808
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014809 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014810 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014811 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014812 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014813 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014814 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014815 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014816
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014817 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14818 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014819 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014820 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014821
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014822cpu_calls : integer
14823 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14824 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14825 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14826 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14827 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14828 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14829
14830cpu_ns_avg : integer
14831 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14832 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14833 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14834 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14835 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14836 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14837 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14838 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14839 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14840 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14841 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14842
14843cpu_ns_tot : integer
14844 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14845 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14846 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14847 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14848 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14849 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14850 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14851 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14852 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14853 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14854 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14855 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14856 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14857
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014858date([<offset>]) : integer
14859 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14860 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14861 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14862 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014863 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14864
14865 Example :
14866
14867 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14868 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014869
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014870date_us : integer
14871 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14872 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14873 from the same timeval structure.
14874
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014875distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14876 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14877 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14878 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14879 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14880 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14881 list of supported tokens.
14882
14883distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14884 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14885 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14886 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14887 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14888 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14889 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14890 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14891 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14892 supported tokens.
14893
14894 Example :
14895 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14896 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14897 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14898 # send large files to the big farm
14899 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14900
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014901env(<name>) : string
14902 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14903 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14904 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14905 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14906 certain way.
14907
14908 Examples :
14909 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14910 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14911
14912 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14913 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014915fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14916 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014917 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14918 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014919 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14920 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014921 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014922 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14923 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014924
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014925fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14926 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14927 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14928 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014930fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14931 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14932 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14933 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14934 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14935 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14936 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14937 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14938 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014939
14940 Example :
14941 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14942 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14943 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14944 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14945 frontend mail
14946 bind :25
14947 mode tcp
14948 maxconn 100
14949 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14950 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14951 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14952 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014953
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014954hostname : string
14955 Returns the system hostname.
14956
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014957int(<integer>) : signed integer
14958 Returns a signed integer.
14959
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014960ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14961 Returns an ipv4.
14962
14963ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14964 Returns an ipv6.
14965
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014966lat_ns_avg : integer
14967 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14968 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14969 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14970 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14971 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14972 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14973 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14974 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14975 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14976 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14977 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14978 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14979 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14980 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14981
14982lat_ns_tot : integer
14983 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14984 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14985 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14986 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14987 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14988 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14989 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14990 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14991 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14992 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14993 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14994 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14995 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14996 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14997 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14998 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14999 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15000 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15001 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15002
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015003meth(<method>) : method
15004 Returns a method.
15005
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015006nbproc : integer
15007 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15008 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15009 and debugging purposes.
15010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015011nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15012 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15013 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15014 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015015 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15016 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15017 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015018
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015019prio_class : integer
15020 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15021 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15022 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15023
15024prio_offset : integer
15025 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15026 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15027 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15028 set-priority-offset".
15029
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015030proc : integer
15031 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15032 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15033 debugging purposes.
15034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015035queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015036 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15037 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15038 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015039 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15040 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15041 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15042 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15043 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15044
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015045rand([<range>]) : integer
15046 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15047 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15048 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15049 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15050 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15051
Luca Schimweg77306662019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015052uuid([<version>]) : string
15053 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15054 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15055 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015057srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15058 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15059 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15060 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15061 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15062 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015063 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15064 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15065
15066srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15067 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15068 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15069 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15070 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15071 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15072 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15073 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15074
15075 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15076 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015077
15078srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15079 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15080 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15081 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015082 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015083 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15084 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15085 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15086
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015087srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15088 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15089 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15090 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15091 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15092 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15093 fetch methods.
15094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015095srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15096 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15097 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015098 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015099 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15100 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015101 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015102 overloading servers).
15103
15104 Example :
15105 # Redirect to a separate back
15106 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15107 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15108 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15109
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015110stopping : boolean
15111 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15112 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15113 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15114
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015115str(<string>) : string
15116 Returns a string.
15117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015118table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15119 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15120 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15121
15122table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15123 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15124 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15125 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15126
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015127thread : integer
15128 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15129 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15130 and debugging purposes.
15131
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015132var(<var-name>) : undefined
15133 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015134 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15135 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015136 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015137 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15138 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015139 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015140 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15141 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015142 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015143 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015144
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151457.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015146----------------------------------
15147
15148The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15149closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15150methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15151sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15152TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015153the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15154counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015155"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15156used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15157can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15158Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15159table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15160tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15161currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015162
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015163bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015164 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15165 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15166 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015168be_id : integer
15169 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15170 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15171
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015172be_name : string
15173 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15174 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015176dst : ip
15177 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15178 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15179 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15180 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015181 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15182 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15183 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15184 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15185 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15186 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015187
15188dst_conn : integer
15189 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15190 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15191 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15192 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15193 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15194 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15195 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15196 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015197
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015198dst_is_local : boolean
15199 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15200 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15201 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15202 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015203 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015204 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15205 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15206 it only once per connection.
15207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015208dst_port : integer
15209 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15210 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15211 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15212 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15213 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15214 an HTTP header.
15215
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015216fc_http_major : integer
15217 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15218 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15219 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15220
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015221fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15222 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15223 header.
15224
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015225fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15226 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15227 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15228 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15229 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15230 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15231 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15232
15233fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15234 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15235 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15236 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15237 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15238 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15239 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15240
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015241fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015242 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15243 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15244 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15245 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15246
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015247fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015248 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15249 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15250 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15251 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15252
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015253fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015254 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15255 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15256 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15257 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15258
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015259fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015260 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15261 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15262 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15263 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15264
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015265fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015266 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15267 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15268 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15269 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15270
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015271fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015272 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15273 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15274 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15275 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15276
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015277fe_defbe : string
15278 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15279 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015281fe_id : integer
15282 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015283 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015284 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15285
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015286fe_name : string
15287 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15288 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15289 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15290
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015291sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015292sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15293sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15294sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015295 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15296 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15297 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15298
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015299sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015300sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15301sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15302sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015303 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15304 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15305 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15306
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015307sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015308sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15309sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15310sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015311 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15312 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015313 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15314 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15315 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015316
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015317 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015318 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15319 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015320 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15321 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15322 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015323 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15324 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15325
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015326sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15327sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15328sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15329sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15330 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15331 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15332 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15333 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15334 when a first ACL was verified.
15335
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015336sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015337sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15338sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15339sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015340 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015341 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15342
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015343sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015344sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15345sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15346sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015347 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15348 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15349 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15350
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015351sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015352sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15353sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15354sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015355 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15356 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15357 See also src_conn_rate.
15358
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015359sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015360sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15361sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15362sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015363 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015364 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015365
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015366sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15367sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15368sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15369sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15370 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15371 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15372
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015373sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15374sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15375sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15376sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15377 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15378 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15379
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015380sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015381sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15382sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15383sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015384 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15385 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15386 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015387 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15388 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15389 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015390
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015391sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15392sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15393sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15394sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15395 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15396 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15397 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15398 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15399 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15400 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15401
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015402sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015403sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15404sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15405sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015406 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015407 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15408 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15409
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015410sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015411sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15412sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15413sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015414 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15415 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15416 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15417 src_http_err_rate.
15418
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015419sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015420sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15421sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15422sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015423 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015424 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15425 src_http_req_cnt.
15426
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015427sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015428sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15429sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15430sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015431 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15432 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15433 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15434 src_http_req_rate.
15435
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015436sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015437sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15438sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15439sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015440 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015441 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15442 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15443 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15444 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015445
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015446 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015447 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15448 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015449 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15450
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015451sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15452sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15453sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15454sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15455 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15456 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15457 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15458 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15459 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15460
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015461sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015462sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15463sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15464sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015465 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15466 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15467 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015468
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015469sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015470sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15471sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15472sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015473 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15474 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15475 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015476
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015477sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015478sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15479sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15480sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015481 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015482 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15483 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15484 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015485 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015486 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15487
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015488sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015489sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15490sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15491sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015492 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15493 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15494 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15495 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15496 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015497 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015498
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015499sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015500sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15501sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15502sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015503 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15504 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15505 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15506
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015507sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015508sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15509sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15510sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015511 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15512 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015513 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015514 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15515 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015516 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15517 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15518 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015520so_id : integer
15521 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15522 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15523 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015524
Jerome Magnin28b90332020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015525so_name : string
15526 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15527 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15528 strings instead of integers.
15529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015530src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015531 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015532 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15533 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15534 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015535 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15536 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15537 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015538 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15539 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15540 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15541 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15542 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15543 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15544 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015545
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015546 Example:
15547 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15548 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015550src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15551 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15552 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15553 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015554 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015556src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15557 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15558 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015559 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015560 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015562src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15563 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15564 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15565 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15566 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15567 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15568 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015569
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015570 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015571 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15572 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15573 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15574 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015575 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015576 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15577 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15578
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015579src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15580 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15581 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15582 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15583 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15584 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15585 was verified.
15586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015587src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015588 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015590 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015591 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015593src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015594 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015595 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15596 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015597 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015599src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15600 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15601 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15602 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015603 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015605src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015606 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015608 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015609 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015610
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015611src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15612 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15613 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15614 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15615 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15616
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015617src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15618 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15619 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15620 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15621 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015624 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015625 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015626 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15627 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015628 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15629 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15630 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015631
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015632src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15633 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15634 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15635 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15636 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15637 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15638 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15639 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015641src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015642 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015644 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015645 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015646 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015648src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15649 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15650 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15651 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15652 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015653 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015655src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015656 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15658 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015659 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015661src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15662 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15663 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15664 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015665 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015666 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015668src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15669 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15670 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15671 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015672 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015673 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15674 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015675
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015676 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015677 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015678 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015679 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015680
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015681src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15682 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15683 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15684 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15685 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15686 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15687 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15688
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015689src_is_local : boolean
15690 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15691 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15692 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15693 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015694 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015695 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15696 once per connection.
15697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015698src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015699 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15700 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15701 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15702 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15703 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015705src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015706 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15707 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15708 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15709 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15710 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015712src_port : integer
15713 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15714 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15715 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15716 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015718src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015719 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015720 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15721 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15722 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015723 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015725src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15726 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15727 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15728 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15729 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015730 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015732src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15733 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15734 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15735 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15736 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15737 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15738 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15739 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15740 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015741
15742 Example :
15743 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15744 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15745 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15746 listen ssh
15747 bind :22
15748 mode tcp
15749 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015750 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015751 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015752 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015754srv_id : integer
15755 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15756 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15757 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015758
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157597.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015760----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15763closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15764when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15765usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015766future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015767
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001576851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15769 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15770 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15771 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15772 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15773 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15774
15775 Example :
15776 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15777 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15778 # the request.
15779 frontend http-in
15780 bind *:8081
15781 default_backend servers
15782 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15783 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15784
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015785ssl_bc : boolean
15786 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15787 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15788 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15789
15790ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15791 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15792 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15793
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015794ssl_bc_alpn : string
15795 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15796 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015797 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015798 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15799 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15800 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15801 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15802 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15803 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15804
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015805ssl_bc_cipher : string
15806 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15807 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15808
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015809ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15810 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15811 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15812 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15813
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015814ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15815 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15816 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15817 session or a TLS ticket.
15818
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015819ssl_bc_npn : string
15820 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15821 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015822 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015823 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15824 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15825 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15826 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15827 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15828
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015829ssl_bc_protocol : string
15830 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15831 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15832
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015833ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015834 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015835 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15836 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015837
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015838ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15839 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15840 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15841 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15842
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015843ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15844 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15845 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15846 if session was reused or not.
15847
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015848ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15849 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15850 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15851 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15852 BoringSSL.
15853
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015854ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15855 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15856 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015858ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15859 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15860 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15861 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15862 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15863 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015865ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15866 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15867 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15868 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15869 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015870
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015871ssl_c_der : binary
15872 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15873 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15874 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015876ssl_c_err : integer
15877 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15878 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15879 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15880 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15881 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015883ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15884 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15885 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15886 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15887 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15888 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15889 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15890 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15891 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015893ssl_c_key_alg : string
15894 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15895 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15896 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898ssl_c_notafter : string
15899 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15900 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15901 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015903ssl_c_notbefore : string
15904 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15905 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15906 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15909 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15910 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15911 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15912 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15913 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15914 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15915 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15916 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015918ssl_c_serial : binary
15919 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15920 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15921 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015923ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15924 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15925 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15926 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015927 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15928 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15929
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015930 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015931 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015933ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15934 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15935 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15936 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938ssl_c_used : boolean
15939 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15940 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015942ssl_c_verify : integer
15943 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15944 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15945 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15946 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015948ssl_c_version : integer
15949 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15950 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015951
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015952ssl_f_der : binary
15953 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15954 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15955 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015957ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15958 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15959 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15960 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15961 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015962 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015963 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15964 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15965 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015967ssl_f_key_alg : string
15968 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15969 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15970 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015972ssl_f_notafter : string
15973 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15974 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15975 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015977ssl_f_notbefore : string
15978 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15979 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15980 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015982ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15983 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15984 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15985 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15986 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15987 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15988 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15989 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15990 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015992ssl_f_serial : binary
15993 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15994 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15995 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015996
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015997ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15998 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15999 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16000 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016002ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16003 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16004 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16005 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007ssl_f_version : integer
16008 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16009 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16010
16011ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016012 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16013 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16014 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016016 Example :
16017 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16018 listen http-https
16019 bind :80
16020 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16021 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16022
16023ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16024 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16025 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16026
16027ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016028 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016029 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16030 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16031 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16032 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16033 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16034 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16035 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16036 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016038ssl_fc_cipher : string
16039 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16040 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016041
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016042ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16043 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16044 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016045 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016046
16047ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16048 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16049 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016050 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016051
16052ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16053 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16054 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16055 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016056 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016057 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016058
16059ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16060 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16061 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016062 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016063
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016064ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16065 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16066 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16067 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016069ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016070 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16071 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016072 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16073 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16074 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16075 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016076
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016077ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16078 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16079 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16080 wait until the handshake happened.
16081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016082ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16083 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016084 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16085 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016086 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016087 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016088
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016089ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016090 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016091 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16092 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016094ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016095 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016096 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16097 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16098 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16099 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16100 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16101 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16102 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016104ssl_fc_protocol : string
16105 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16106 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016107
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016108ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016109 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016110 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16111 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016112
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016113ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16114 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16115 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16116 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016118ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16119 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16120 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16121 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16122 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016123
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016124ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16125 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16126 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16127 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16128 BoringSSL.
16129
16130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016131ssl_fc_sni : string
16132 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16133 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16134 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16135 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16136 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16137
16138 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16139 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16140 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016141 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016142 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016144 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016145 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16146 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016148ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16149 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16150 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016151
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016152
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161537.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016154------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016156Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16157sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16158only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16159For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16160be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16161can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16162sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16163for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16164content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016166payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016167 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016168 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16169 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016171payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16172 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016173 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016174 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016175
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016176req.hdrs : string
16177 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16178 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16179 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16180 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16181
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016182req.hdrs_bin : binary
16183 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16184 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16185 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16186 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16187 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16188 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16189
16190 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16191
16192 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16193 str: <int:length><bytes>
16194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016195req.len : integer
16196req_len : integer (deprecated)
16197 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16198 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16199 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16200 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16201 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16202 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16203 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16204 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016206req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16207 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016208 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16209 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16210 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16211 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016213 ACL alternatives :
16214 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016216req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16217 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16218 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16219 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16220 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016222 ACL alternatives :
16223 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016225 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016227req.proto_http : boolean
16228req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16229 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16230 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16231 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16232 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16233 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16234 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16235 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016237 Example:
16238 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16239 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16240 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016241 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016243req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16244rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16245 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16246 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16247 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16248 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16249 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16250 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16251 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016253 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16254 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16255 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16256 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16257 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16258 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016260 ACL derivatives :
16261 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016263 Example :
16264 listen tse-farm
16265 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16266 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16267 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16268 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16269 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16270 persist rdp-cookie
16271 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16272 # This is only useful makes sense if
16273 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16274 stick-table type string size 204800
16275 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16276 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16277 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016279 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16280 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016282req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16283rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16284 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16285 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16286 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16287 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016289 ACL derivatives :
16290 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016291
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016292req.ssl_alpn : string
16293 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16294 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16295 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16296 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16297 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16298 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016299 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016300
16301 Examples :
16302 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16303 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16304 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016305 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016306 default_backend bk_default
16307
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016308req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16309 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16310 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016311 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16312 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16313 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16314 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16315 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016317req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16318req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16319 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16320 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16321 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16322 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16323 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16324 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16325 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016327req.ssl_sni : string
16328req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16329 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16330 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16331 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16332 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16333 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16334 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16335 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16336 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16337 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16338 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16339 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16340 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016342 ACL derivatives :
16343 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016345 Examples :
16346 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16347 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16348 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16349 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16350 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016351
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016352req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16353 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16354 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16355 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16356 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16357 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16358 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16359 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16360 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16361 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016363req.ssl_ver : integer
16364req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16365 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16366 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16367 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16368 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16369 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16370 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16371 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016372 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016373 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016375 ACL derivatives :
16376 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016377
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016378res.len : integer
16379 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16380 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16381 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16382 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16383 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16384 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16385 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16386 content inspection.
16387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016388res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16389 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016390 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16391 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16392 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16393 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016395res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16396 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16397 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16398 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16399 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016401 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016402
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016403res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16404rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16405 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16406 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16407 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16408 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16409 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16410 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16411 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016413wait_end : boolean
16414 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16415 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016416 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016417 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16418 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016419 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016420 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16421 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016423 Examples :
16424 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16425 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16426 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016428 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16429 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16430 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16431 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16432 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16433 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16434 tcp-request content reject
16435
16436
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200164377.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016438--------------------------------------
16439
16440It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16441This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16442data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16443its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16444HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16445content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16446to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16447more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16448response are indexed.
16449
16450base : string
16451 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16452 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16453 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16454 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16455 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16456 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16457 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16458 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16459
16460 ACL derivatives :
16461 base : exact string match
16462 base_beg : prefix match
16463 base_dir : subdir match
16464 base_dom : domain match
16465 base_end : suffix match
16466 base_len : length match
16467 base_reg : regex match
16468 base_sub : substring match
16469
16470base32 : integer
16471 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16472 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16473 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016474 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16475 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16476 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016477
16478base32+src : binary
16479 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16480 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16481 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16482 per-URL counters.
16483
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016484capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16485 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16486 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16487 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16488
16489capture.req.method : string
16490 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16491 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16492 because it's allocated.
16493
16494capture.req.uri : string
16495 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16496 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16497 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16498 allocated.
16499
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016500capture.req.ver : string
16501 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16502 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16503 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16504
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016505capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16506 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16507 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16508 The first entry is an index of 0.
16509 See also: "capture response header"
16510
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016511capture.res.ver : string
16512 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16513 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16514 persistent flag.
16515
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016516req.body : binary
16517 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16518 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16519 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16520 the first chunk is analyzed.
16521
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016522req.body_param([<name>) : string
16523 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16524 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16525 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16526 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16527 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16528 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16529 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16530 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16531 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16532 given.
16533
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016534req.body_len : integer
16535 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16536 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16537 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16538 "option http-buffer-request".
16539
16540req.body_size : integer
16541 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16542 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16543 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16544 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16545 "option http-buffer-request".
16546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016547req.cook([<name>]) : string
16548cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16549 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16550 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16551 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16552 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16553 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16554 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16555 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16556 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16557
16558 ACL derivatives :
16559 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16560 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16561 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16562 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16563 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16564 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16565 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16566 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016568req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16569cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16570 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16571 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016573req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16574cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16575 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16576 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16577 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16578 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016580cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16581 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16582 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16583 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16584 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016585 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016586 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16587 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16588 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16589 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016591hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16592 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16593 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16594 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16595 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016596 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016598req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16599 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16600 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16601 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16602 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16603 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16604 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16605 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16606 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016608req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16609 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16610 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16611 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16612 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016614req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16615 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16616 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16617 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16618 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16619 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16620 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16621 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16622 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016623 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016624 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016625 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016627 ACL derivatives :
16628 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16629 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16630 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16631 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16632 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16633 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16634 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16635 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16636
16637req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16638hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16639 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16640 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16641 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16642 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16643 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16644 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16645 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16646 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16647 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16648
16649req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16650hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16651 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16652 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16653 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16654 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16655 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016656 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016657 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16658 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16659
16660req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16661hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16662 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16663 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16664 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16665 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16666 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16667 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16668 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16669
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016670
16671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016672http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16673 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16674 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16675 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16676 basic auth is supported.
16677
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016678http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16679 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16680 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16681 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16682 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016683 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16684 basic auth is supported.
16685
16686 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016687 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16688 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16689 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16690 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016691
16692http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016693 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16694 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016695 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16696 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016698method : integer + string
16699 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16700 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16701 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16702 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16703 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16704 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16705 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016707 ACL derivatives :
16708 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016710 Example :
16711 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16712 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16713 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016715path : string
16716 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16717 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16718 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16719 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16720 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016721 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016722 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016724 ACL derivatives :
16725 path : exact string match
16726 path_beg : prefix match
16727 path_dir : subdir match
16728 path_dom : domain match
16729 path_end : suffix match
16730 path_len : length match
16731 path_reg : regex match
16732 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016733
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016734query : string
16735 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16736 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16737 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16738 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016739 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016740 which stops before the question mark.
16741
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016742req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16743 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16744 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16745 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16746 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016748req.ver : string
16749req_ver : string (deprecated)
16750 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16751 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16752 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016754 ACL derivatives :
16755 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016757res.comp : boolean
16758 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16759 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16760 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016762res.comp_algo : string
16763 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16764 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16765 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016767res.cook([<name>]) : string
16768scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16769 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16770 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16771 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016773 ACL derivatives :
16774 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016776res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16777scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16778 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16779 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16780 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016782res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16783scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16784 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16785 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16786 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016788res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16789 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16790 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16791 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16792 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16793 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16794 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16795 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16796 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16797 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016799res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16800 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16801 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16802 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16803 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16804 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016806res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16807shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16808 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16809 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16810 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16811 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16812 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16813 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16814 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16815 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016817 ACL derivatives :
16818 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16819 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16820 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16821 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16822 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16823 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16824 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16825 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16826
16827res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16828shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16829 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16830 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16831 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16832 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16833 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016835res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16836shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16837 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16838 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16839 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16840 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16841 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16842 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016843
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016844res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16845 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16846 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16847 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16848 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016850res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16851shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16852 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16853 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16854 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16855 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16856 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16857 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016859res.ver : string
16860resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16861 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16862 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016864 ACL derivatives :
16865 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016867set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16868 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16869 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016870 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016871 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016873 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16874 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016876status : integer
16877 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16878 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16879 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016880
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016881unique-id : string
16882 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16883 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16884 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16885 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16886 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16887 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016889url : string
16890 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16891 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16892 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16893 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16894 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16895 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16896 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016898 ACL derivatives :
16899 url : exact string match
16900 url_beg : prefix match
16901 url_dir : subdir match
16902 url_dom : domain match
16903 url_end : suffix match
16904 url_len : length match
16905 url_reg : regex match
16906 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016908url_ip : ip
16909 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16910 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16911 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16912 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16913 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16914 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16915 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016917url_port : integer
16918 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16919 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16920 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16921 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016922
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016923urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16924url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016925 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16926 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016927 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16928 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16929 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16930 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016931 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16932 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016933 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16934 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016936 ACL derivatives :
16937 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16938 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16939 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16940 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16941 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16942 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16943 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16944 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016945
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016947 Example :
16948 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16949 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16950 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16951 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016952
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016953urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016954 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16955 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16956 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016957
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016958url32 : integer
16959 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16960 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16961 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16962 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16963 is an unsigned integer.
16964
16965url32+src : binary
16966 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16967 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16968 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16969
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169717.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016972---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016974Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16975every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016976order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016977
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016978ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16979---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016980FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016981HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016982HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16983HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016984HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16985HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16986HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16987HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16988LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016989METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016990METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016991METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16992METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16993METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16994METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016995METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016996METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016997RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016998REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016999TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017000WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
17001---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010017002
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010017003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170048. Logging
17005----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017006
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017007One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
17008provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
17009very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
17010provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
17011state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017012to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017013headers.
17014
17015In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
17016about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
17017send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
17018
17019 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
17020 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
17021 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
17022 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
17023 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017024 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060017025 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017026
17027The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
17028allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
17029as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
17030while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
17031real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
17032delay.
17033
17034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170358.1. Log levels
17036---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017037
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017038TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017039source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017040HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
17041in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17042track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17043syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17044about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017045
17046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170478.2. Log formats
17048----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017049
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017050HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017051and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17052slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17053options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017054
17055 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17056 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17057 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17058 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17059 extents.
17060
17061 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17062 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17063 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17064 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17065 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17066
17067 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17068 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17069 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17070 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17071 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17072
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017073 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17074 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17075 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17076 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17077
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017078 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17079
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017080Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17081specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17082field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17083servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17084always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17085identifier.
17086
17087Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17088 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17089 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17090 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17091 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17092
17093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170948.2.1. Default log format
17095-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017096
17097This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17098as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17099format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17100
17101 Example :
17102 listen www
17103 mode http
17104 log global
17105 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17106
17107 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17108 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17109 (www/HTTP)
17110
17111 Field Format Extract from the example above
17112 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17113 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17114 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17115 4 'to' to
17116 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17117 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17118
17119Detailed fields description :
17120 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17121 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17122 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17123 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17124 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17125 and processed the connection.
17126 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17127
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017128In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17129"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17130connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17131
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017132It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17133will eventually disappear.
17134
17135
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171368.2.2. TCP log format
17137---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017138
17139The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17140is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17141information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17142counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17143emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17144environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17145the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17146sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017147specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17148not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17149fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17150marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017151
17152 Example :
17153 frontend fnt
17154 mode tcp
17155 option tcplog
17156 log global
17157 default_backend bck
17158
17159 backend bck
17160 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17161
17162 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17163 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17164 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17165
17166 Field Format Extract from the example above
17167 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17168 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17169 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17170 4 frontend_name fnt
17171 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17172 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17173 7 bytes_read* 212
17174 8 termination_state --
17175 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17176 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17177
17178Detailed fields description :
17179 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017180 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17181 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17182 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017183 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017184 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017185 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017186
17187 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017188 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17189 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17190 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017191
17192 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17193 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17194 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017195 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17196 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17197 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17198 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017199
17200 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17201 and processed the connection.
17202
17203 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17204 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17205 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17206 applications.
17207
17208 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17209 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17210 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17211 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17212 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17213
17214 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17215 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17216 See "Timers" below for more details.
17217
17218 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17219 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17220 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17221 "Timers" below for more details.
17222
17223 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017224 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017225 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17226 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17227 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17228 details.
17229
17230 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17231 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17232 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17233 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17234 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17235
17236 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17237 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17238 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17239 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17240 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17241 for more details.
17242
17243 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017244 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017245 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17246 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17247 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017248 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017249
17250 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17251 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17252 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17253 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17254 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17255 caused by a denial of service attack.
17256
17257 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17258 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17259 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17260 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17261 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17262 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17263 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17264 denial of service attack.
17265
17266 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17267 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17268 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17269 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17270 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17271 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17272 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17273 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17274 be processed than on other servers.
17275
17276 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17277 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17278 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17279 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17280 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17281 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17282 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17283 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17284 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17285 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17286 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17287 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17288 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17289
17290 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17291 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17292 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17293 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17294 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17295 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017296 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017297 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17298
17299 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17300 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17301 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17302 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17303 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17304 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017305 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017306 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17307 occurs.
17308
17309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173108.2.3. HTTP log format
17311----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017312
17313The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17314is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17315the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17316are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17317emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17318generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17319"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17320which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017321frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17322is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017323
17324Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17325slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17326with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17327
17328 Example :
17329 frontend http-in
17330 mode http
17331 option httplog
17332 log global
17333 default_backend bck
17334
17335 backend static
17336 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17337
17338 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17339 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17340 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017341 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017342
17343 Field Format Extract from the example above
17344 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17345 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017346 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017347 4 frontend_name http-in
17348 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017349 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017350 7 status_code 200
17351 8 bytes_read* 2750
17352 9 captured_request_cookie -
17353 10 captured_response_cookie -
17354 11 termination_state ----
17355 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17356 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17357 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17358 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17359 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017360
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017361Detailed fields description :
17362 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017363 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17364 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17365 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017366 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017367 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017368 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017369
17370 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017371 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17372 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17373 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017374
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017375 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17376 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017377
17378 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17379 and processed the connection.
17380
17381 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17382 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17383 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17384
17385 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17386 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17387 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17388 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17389 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17390 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17391
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017392 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17393 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17394 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017395 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017396 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17397 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017398 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17399 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017400
17401 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17402 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017403 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017404
17405 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17406 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017407 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17408 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017409
17410 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17411 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17412 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17413 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17414 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017415 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17416 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017417
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017418 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17419 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17420 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17421 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17422 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17423 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17424 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017425 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017426
17427 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17428 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17429 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17430
17431 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17432 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017433 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017434 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17435 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17436 overflowing.
17437
17438 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17439 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17440 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17441 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17442 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17443 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17444 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17445 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17446
17447 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17448 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17449 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17450 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17451 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17452 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17453 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17454 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17455
17456 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17457 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17458 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17459 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17460 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17461 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17462 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17463
17464 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017465 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017466 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17467 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17468 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017469 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017470 system.
17471
17472 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17473 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17474 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17475 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17476 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17477 caused by a denial of service attack.
17478
17479 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17480 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17481 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17482 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17483 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17484 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17485 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17486 denial of service attack.
17487
17488 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17489 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17490 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17491 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17492 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17493 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17494 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17495 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17496 processed than on other servers.
17497
17498 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17499 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17500 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17501 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17502 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17503 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17504 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17505 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17506 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17507 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17508 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17509 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17510 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17511
17512 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17513 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17514 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17515 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17516 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17517 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017518 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017519 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17520
17521 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17522 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17523 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17524 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17525 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17526 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017527 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017528 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17529 occurs.
17530
17531 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17532 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17533 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17534 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17535 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17536 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17537 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17538 cookies" below for more details.
17539
17540 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17541 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17542 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17543 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17544 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17545 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17546 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17547 and cookies" below for more details.
17548
17549 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17550 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17551 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17552 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17553 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17554 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17555 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17556 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17557
17558
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200175598.2.4. Custom log format
17560------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017561
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017562The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017563mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017564
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017565HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017566Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17567separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17568prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17569
17570Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17571variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017572("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017573
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017574If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017575as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017576less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17577the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17578
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017579Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017580In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017581in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017582
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017583Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17584'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17585https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17586such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17587
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017588Flags are :
17589 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017590 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017591 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17592 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017593
17594 Example:
17595
17596 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17597 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17598
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017599 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17600
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017601At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17602
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017603 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17604 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017605
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017606the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017607
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017608 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17609 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17610 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017611
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017612and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17613
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017614 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17615 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017616
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017617Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17618
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017619 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017620 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017621 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17622 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17623 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017624 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17625 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17626 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017627 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017628 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17629 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017630 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017631 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17632 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017633 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017634 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017635 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017636 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017637 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017638 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017639 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017640 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17641 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17642 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17643 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17644 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017645 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017646 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17647 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017648 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017649 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17650 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017651 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17652 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17653 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017654 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017655 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17656 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017657 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017658 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17659 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17660 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017661 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017662 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017663 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17664 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17665 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17666 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017667 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017668 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017669 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017670 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017671 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017672 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017673 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17674 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17675 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017676 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017677 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17678 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017679 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017680 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17681 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017682 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017683 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017684 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017685 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017686
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017687 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017688
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017689
176908.2.5. Error log format
17691-----------------------
17692
17693When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17694protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17695By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17696"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017697will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017698logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17699
17700The format looks like this :
17701
17702 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17703 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17704 Connection error during SSL handshake
17705
17706 Field Format Extract from the example above
17707 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17708 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17709 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17710 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17711 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17712
17713These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17714failures.
17715
17716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177178.3. Advanced logging options
17718-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017719
17720Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17721just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17722options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17723for more information about their usage.
17724
17725
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177268.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17727------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017728
17729It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17730haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17731commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17732monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17733ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17734
17735 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17736 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17737 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17738 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17739
17740 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17741 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17742 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017743 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017744 such as other load-balancers.
17745
17746 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17747 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17748 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17749
17750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177518.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17752----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017753
17754The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17755what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17756or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017757"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017758just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17759log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17760after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17761is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17762with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17763with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17764
17765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177668.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17767------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017768
17769Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17770for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17771"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17772retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17773raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17774a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17775file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17776you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17777"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17778
17779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177808.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17781--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017782
17783Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17784multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17785them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17786"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17787logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17788error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17789and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17790too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17791useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17792alternative.
17793
17794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177958.4. Timing events
17796------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017797
17798Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17799reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17800the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17801frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017802mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17803addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17804
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017805Timings events in HTTP mode:
17806
17807 first request 2nd request
17808 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17809 t tr t tr ...
17810 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17811 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17812 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17813 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17814 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17815
17816Timings events in TCP mode:
17817
17818 TCP session
17819 |<----------------->|
17820 t t
17821 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17822 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17823 |<------ Tt ------->|
17824
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017825 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017826 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017827 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17828 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17829 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017830 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017831 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17832 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17833 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17834 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017835
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017836 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17837 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17838 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017839 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17840 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17841 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17842 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17843 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17844 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017845
17846 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17847 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17848 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17849 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17850 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17851 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17852 request typed by hand during a test.
17853
17854 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17855 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017856 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017857 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17858 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17859 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17860 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017861
17862 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17863 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17864 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17865 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17866 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17867
17868 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17869 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17870 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17871 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17872 connection never established.
17873
17874 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17875 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17876 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17877 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17878 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17879 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17880 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17881 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17882 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17883 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17884 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17885
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017886 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17887 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17888 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17889 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17890 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17891 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17892
17893 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17894
17895 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17896 "Ta" can never be negative.
17897
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017898 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17899 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017900 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17901 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017902 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017903
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017904 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017905
17906 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017907 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17908 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017909
17910These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17911protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17912that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017913due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17914"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17915that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017916
17917Most common cases :
17918
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017919 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17920 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17921 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17922 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17923 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17924 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17925 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17926 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17927 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17928 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17929 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017930 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017931
17932 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17933 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17934 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17935 of ms on remote networks.
17936
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017937 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17938 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17939 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017940
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017941 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17942 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17943 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17944 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17945 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17946 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17947 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17948 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17949 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017950
17951Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17952
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017953 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017954 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017955 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017956
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017957 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017958 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17959 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17960
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017961 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017962 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17963 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17964 flags.
17965
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017966 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17967 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017968 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17969 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17970 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17971 the client connection was maintained open.
17972
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017973 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017974 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017975 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017976 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17977
17978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179798.5. Session state at disconnection
17980-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017981
17982TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17983"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
179842-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17985each of which has a special meaning :
17986
17987 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17988 session to terminate :
17989
17990 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17991
17992 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17993 server explicitly refused it.
17994
17995 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17996 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17997 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17998 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017999 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018000
18001 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
18002 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018003
18004 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
18005 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
18006 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
18007 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
18008 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
18009
18010 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
18011 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
18012 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
18013 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
18014 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
18015
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090018016 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
18017 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
18018
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070018019 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
18020 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
18021 backup connections when going up.
18022
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020018023 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
18024
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018025 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
18026 send or receive data.
18027
18028 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
18029 send or receive data.
18030
18031 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
18032 with nothing left in the buffers.
18033
18034 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
18035
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010018036 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018037 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
18038
18039 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
18040 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
18041 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18042 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18043 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18044
18045 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18046 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18047
18048 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18049 server (HTTP only).
18050
18051 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18052
18053 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18054 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18055 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18056
18057 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18058 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18059 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18060
18061 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18062
18063 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18064 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18065
18066 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18067 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18068 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18069
18070 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18071 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018072 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18073 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018074
18075 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18076 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18077 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18078 another server.
18079
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018080 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018081 server.
18082
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018083 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18084 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18085 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18086 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18087
18088 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18089 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18090 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18091 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18092
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018093 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18094 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18095 "use-server" rule).
18096
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018097 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18098
18099 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18100 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18101
18102 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18103
18104 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18105 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18106 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18107
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018108 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18109 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018110 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018111 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18112 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18113
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018114 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18115
18116 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18117 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18118
18119 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18120
18121 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18122
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018123The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18124was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018125helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18126starvation, attacks, etc...
18127
18128The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18129alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18130easier finding and understanding.
18131
18132 Flags Reason
18133
18134 -- Normal termination.
18135
18136 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18137 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18138 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18139 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18140
18141 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18142 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18143 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18144 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18145 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18146 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018147
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018148 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18149 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018150 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018151
18152 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18153 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18154 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18155
18156 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18157 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18158 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18159 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18160 the server takes too long to respond.
18161
18162 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18163 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18164 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18165 long a time to respond.
18166
18167 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18168 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18169 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18170 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018171 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18172 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018173
18174 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18175 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18176 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18177 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18178 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018179 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018180 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18181 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18182 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18183 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18184 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18185 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18186 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18187 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018188 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018189 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18190 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18191 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018192
18193 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18194 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018195 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18196 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18197 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18198 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018199
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018200 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18201 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018203 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018204 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18205 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018206 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018207 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18208 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18209
18210 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18211 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18212 503 or 504 here.
18213
18214 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18215 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18216 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18217 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18218 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18219
18220 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18221 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018222 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018223 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18224 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18225
18226 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18227 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18228 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18229 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18230 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18231 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18232 between haproxy and the server.
18233
18234 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18235 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18236 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18237 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18238 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18239 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18240 solution is to fix the application.
18241
18242 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18243 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18244 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18245 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18246 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18247 external attacks.
18248
18249 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18250 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018251 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018252 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18253 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18254
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018255 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18256 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18257 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018258 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018259 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018260
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018261 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18262 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18263 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18264 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018265 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18266 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18267 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18268 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18269 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018270
18271 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18272 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18273 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18274 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18275
18276 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18277 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18278 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18279 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18280
18281 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18282 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18283 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18284 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18285
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018286The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18287persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18288important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18289re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18290
18291 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18292
18293 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18294 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18295 set on a GET request.
18296
18297 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18298 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018299 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018300 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18301
18302 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18303 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18304 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18305
18306 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18307 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18308 already got a cookie.
18309
18310 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18311 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18312 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18313 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18314 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18315
18316 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18317 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18318 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18319
18320 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18321 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18322 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18323
18324 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18325 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18326
18327 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18328 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18329 then advertised in the response.
18330
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183328.6. Non-printable characters
18333-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018334
18335In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18336consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18337converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18338prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18339being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18340escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18341is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18342'}' when logging headers.
18343
18344Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18345issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18346containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18347
18348Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18349the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18350performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18351
18352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183538.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18354---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018355
18356Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18357achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018358section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018359cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18360the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18361the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018362locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018363not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18364user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18365a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18366wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18367
18368 Examples :
18369 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18370 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18371
18372 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18373 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18374
18375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183768.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18377---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018378
18379Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18380proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18381the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18382server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18383
18384Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18385response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018386section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018387
18388It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018389time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18390appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018391are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18392and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18393follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18394request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18395in the logs.
18396
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018397As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18398frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18399an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18400
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018401 Example :
18402 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18403 listen proxy-out
18404 mode http
18405 option httplog
18406 option logasap
18407 log global
18408 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18409
18410 # log the name of the virtual server
18411 capture request header Host len 20
18412
18413 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18414 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18415
18416 # log the beginning of the referrer
18417 capture request header Referer len 20
18418
18419 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18420 capture response header Server len 20
18421
18422 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18423 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18424
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018425 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018426 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18427
18428 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18429 capture response header Via len 20
18430
18431 # log the URL location during a redirection
18432 capture response header Location len 20
18433
18434 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18435 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18436 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18437 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18438 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18439
18440 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18441 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18442 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18443 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018444 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018445
18446 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18447 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18448 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18449 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18450 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018451 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018452
18453
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184548.9. Examples of logs
18455---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018456
18457These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18458them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18459reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18460
18461 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18462 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18463 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18464
18465 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18466 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18467
18468 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18469 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18470 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18471
18472 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18473 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18474
18475 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18476 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18477 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18478
18479 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018480 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018481 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18482 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18483
18484 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18485 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18486 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18487
18488 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18489 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018490 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018491 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18492 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18493 to return the 502 and not the server.
18494
18495 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018496 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018497
18498 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18499 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18500 Nothing was sent to any server.
18501
18502 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18503 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18504
18505 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18506 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018507 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018508 send a 408 return code to the client.
18509
18510 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18511 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18512
18513 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18514 5 seconds ("c----").
18515
18516 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18517 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018518 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018519
18520 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018521 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018522 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18523 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18524 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18525 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18526 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018527
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018528
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200185299. Supported filters
18530--------------------
18531
18532Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18533accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18534unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18535
18536See also : "filter"
18537
185389.1. Trace
18539----------
18540
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018541filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018542
18543 Arguments:
18544 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18545 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18546
18547 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18548 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18549 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18550 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18551
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018552 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018553 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18554 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18555 amount of the parsed data.
18556
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018557 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018558
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018559This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18560callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18561information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18562filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18563
18564Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18565tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18566a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18567
18568
185699.2. HTTP compression
18570---------------------
18571
18572filter compression
18573
18574The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18575keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018576when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18577it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18578response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18579line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18580cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18581the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018582
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018583See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018584
18585
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200185869.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18587--------------------------------------------
18588
18589filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18590
18591 Arguments :
18592
18593 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18594 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18595 parsed.
18596
18597 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18598 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18599 part must be placed in its own scope.
18600
18601The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18602external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018603streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018604exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18605also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18606
18607SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18608the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18609
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018610For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018611"doc/SPOE.txt".
18612
18613Important note:
18614 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18615 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18616
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100186179.4. Cache
18618----------
18619
18620filter cache <name>
18621
18622 Arguments :
18623
18624 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18625
18626The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18627"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018628cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018629other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18630the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18631mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18632filter other than the compression is used for the same
18633listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18634order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018635
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018636See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018637
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001863810. Cache
18639---------
18640
18641HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18642(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18643RAM.
18644
18645The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018646this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018647
18648If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18649independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18650when we try to allocate a new one.
18651
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018652The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018653
18654It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18655"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18656for more details.
18657
18658When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18659replaced by "<CACHE>".
18660
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001866110.1. Limitation
18662----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018663
18664The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18665
18666- If the response is not a 200
18667- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018668- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018669- If the response is not cacheable
18670
18671- If the request is not a GET
18672- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018673- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018674
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018675Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18676filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18677can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18678example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18679"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018680
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001868110.2. Setup
18682-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018683
18684To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18685the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18686
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001868710.2.1. Cache section
18688---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018689
18690cache <name>
18691 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18692 size of cache is mandatory.
18693
18694total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018695 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018696 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018697
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018698max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018699 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18700 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18701 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018702
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018703max-age <seconds>
18704 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18705 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18706 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18707 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18708 default.
18709
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001871010.2.2. Proxy section
18711---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018712
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018713http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018714 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18715 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18716 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18717 after this one.
18718
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018719http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018720 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18721 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18722 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18723 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18724
18725
18726Example:
18727
18728 backend bck1
18729 mode http
18730
18731 http-request cache-use foobar
18732 http-response cache-store foobar
18733 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18734
18735 cache foobar
18736 total-max-size 4
18737 max-age 240
18738
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018739/*
18740 * Local variables:
18741 * fill-column: 79
18742 * End:
18743 */